(Qutf_8): Moved to coding.c
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 1999, 2000, 01, 02, 2003
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
21
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24
25 #include <config.h>
26
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
30
31 #include <stdio.h>
32
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
34
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
37
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
41
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
46
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
52
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
56
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
59
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
69
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
88
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
92
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
99
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
103
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
108
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
110
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
115
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
121
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
123
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
129
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #define ARROW_SCROLLBAR
134 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ScrollbarP.h>
135 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
136 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
137 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
138 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
139 #ifndef XtNpickTop
140 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
141 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
142 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
143 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
144
145 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
146
147 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
148 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
149 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
150 #endif
151
152 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
153 #include "widget.h"
154 #ifndef XtNinitialState
155 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
156 #endif
157 #endif
158
159 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
160
161 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
162 int use_xim = 1;
163 \f
164
165 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
166
167 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
168
169 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
170 start. */
171
172 static int any_help_event_p;
173
174 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
175 static Lisp_Object last_window;
176
177 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
178
179 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
180
181 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
182 use. */
183
184 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
185
186 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
187 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
188 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
189 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
190
191 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
192
193 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
194 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
195 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
196 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
197
198 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
199
200 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
201
202 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
203
204 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
205 /* The application context for Xt use. */
206 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
207 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
208 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
209
210 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
211
212 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
213
214 /* Mouse movement.
215
216 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
217 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
218 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
219 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
220
221 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
222
223 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
224 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
225 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
226 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
227 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
228 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
229 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
230 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
231 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
232 is off. */
233
234 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
235
236 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
237 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
238
239 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
240
241 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
242 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
243 an ordinary motion.
244
245 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
246 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
247 event. */
248
249 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
250
251 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
252 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
253 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
254 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
255 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
256 it's somewhat accurate. */
257
258 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
259
260 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
261 events. */
262
263 #ifdef __STDC__
264 static int volatile input_signal_count;
265 #else
266 static int input_signal_count;
267 #endif
268
269 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
270
271 static int x_noop_count;
272
273 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
274
275 extern char **initial_argv;
276 extern int initial_argc;
277
278 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
279
280 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
281
282 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
283
284 extern Lisp_Object Qface, Qmouse_face, Qeql;
285
286 extern int errno;
287
288 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
289
290 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
291
292 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
293
294 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
295 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
296 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
297
298 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
299 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
300
301 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
302
303
304 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
305 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
306 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
307 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
308 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
309 static unsigned int x_x_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
310 unsigned));
311 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
312 int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
313 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
314 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
315 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
316 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
317 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
318 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
319 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
320 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
321 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
322 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
323 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
324 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
325 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
326 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
327 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
328 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
329 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
330 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
331 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
332 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
333 static int x_focus_changed P_ ((int,
334 int,
335 struct x_display_info *,
336 struct frame *,
337 struct input_event *,
338 int));
339 static int x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
340 XEvent *,
341 struct input_event *,
342 int));
343 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
344 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
345 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
346 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
347 enum text_cursor_kinds));
348
349 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, GC));
350 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
351 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
352 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
353 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
354 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Window));
355 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
356 enum scroll_bar_part *,
357 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
358 unsigned long *));
359 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
360 static void x_check_fullscreen_move P_ ((struct frame *));
361 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
362 XEvent *,
363 struct input_event **,
364 int *,
365 int *));
366
367
368 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
369
370 static void
371 x_flush (f)
372 struct frame *f;
373 {
374 BLOCK_INPUT;
375 if (f == NULL)
376 {
377 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
378 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
379 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
380 }
381 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
382 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
383 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
384 }
385
386
387 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
388 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
389 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
390 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
391 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
392 performance. */
393
394 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
395
396 \f
397 /***********************************************************************
398 Debugging
399 ***********************************************************************/
400
401 #if 0
402
403 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
404 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
405
406 struct record
407 {
408 char *locus;
409 int type;
410 };
411
412 struct record event_record[100];
413
414 int event_record_index;
415
416 record_event (locus, type)
417 char *locus;
418 int type;
419 {
420 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
421 event_record_index = 0;
422
423 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
424 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
425 event_record_index++;
426 }
427
428 #endif /* 0 */
429
430
431 \f
432 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
433
434 struct x_display_info *
435 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
436 Display *dpy;
437 {
438 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
439
440 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
441 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
442 return dpyinfo;
443
444 return 0;
445 }
446
447
448 \f
449 /***********************************************************************
450 Starting and ending an update
451 ***********************************************************************/
452
453 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
454 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
455 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
456 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
457 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
458
459 static void
460 x_update_begin (f)
461 struct frame *f;
462 {
463 /* Nothing to do. */
464 }
465
466
467 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
468 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
469 position of W. */
470
471 static void
472 x_update_window_begin (w)
473 struct window *w;
474 {
475 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
476 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
477
478 updated_window = w;
479 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
480
481 BLOCK_INPUT;
482
483 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
484 {
485 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
486 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
487
488 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
489 highlighting. */
490 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
491 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
492
493 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
494 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
495 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
496 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
497 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
498 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
499
500 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
501 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
502 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
503 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
504 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
505 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
506 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
507 {
508 int i;
509
510 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
511 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
512 break;
513
514 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
515 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
516 }
517 #endif /* 0 */
518 }
519
520 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
521 }
522
523
524 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
525
526 static void
527 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
528 struct window *w;
529 int x, y0, y1;
530 {
531 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
532
533 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
534 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
535 }
536
537 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
538
539 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
540 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
541
542 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
543 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
544 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
545
546 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
547 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
548 here. */
549
550 static void
551 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
552 struct window *w;
553 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
554 {
555 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
556
557 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
558 {
559 BLOCK_INPUT;
560
561 if (cursor_on_p)
562 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
563 output_cursor.vpos,
564 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
565
566 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
567 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
568 }
569
570 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
571 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
572 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
573 {
574 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
575 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
576 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
577 }
578
579 updated_window = NULL;
580 }
581
582
583 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
584 update_end. */
585
586 static void
587 x_update_end (f)
588 struct frame *f;
589 {
590 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
591 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
592
593 #ifndef XFlush
594 BLOCK_INPUT;
595 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
596 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
597 #endif
598 }
599
600
601 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
602 complete update has been performed. The global variable
603 updated_window is not available here. */
604
605 static void
606 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
607 struct frame *f;
608 {
609 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
610 {
611 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
612
613 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
614 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
615 {
616 BLOCK_INPUT;
617 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
618 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
619 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
620 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
621 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
622 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
623 }
624 }
625 }
626
627
628 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
629 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
630 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
631 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
632 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
633 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
634
635 static void
636 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
637 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
638 {
639 struct window *w = updated_window;
640 struct frame *f;
641 int width, height;
642
643 xassert (w);
644
645 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
646 {
647 BLOCK_INPUT;
648 draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, desired_row);
649 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
650 }
651
652 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
653 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
654 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
655 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
656 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
657 overhead is very small. */
658 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
659 && desired_row->full_width_p
660 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
661 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
662 width != 0)
663 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
664 height > 0))
665 {
666 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
667
668 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
669 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
670 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
671 y -= width;
672
673 BLOCK_INPUT;
674 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
675 0, y, width, height, False);
676 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
677 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
678 y, width, height, False);
679 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
680 }
681 }
682
683 static void
684 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
685 struct window *w;
686 struct glyph_row *row;
687 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
688 {
689 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
690 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
691 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
692 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
693 struct face *face = p->face;
694
695 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
696 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
697
698 if (p->bx >= 0)
699 {
700 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
701 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
702 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
703 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
704 if (face->stipple)
705 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
706 else
707 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
708
709 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
710 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
711
712 if (!face->stipple)
713 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
714 }
715
716 if (p->which != NO_FRINGE_BITMAP)
717 {
718 unsigned char *bits = fringe_bitmaps[p->which].bits + p->dh;
719 Pixmap pixmap;
720 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
721
722 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
723 by the server. */
724 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
725 face->foreground,
726 face->background, depth);
727 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
728 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
729 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
730 }
731
732 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
733 }
734
735 \f
736
737 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
738 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
739 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
740 rarely happens). */
741
742 static void
743 XTset_terminal_modes ()
744 {
745 }
746
747 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
748 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
749
750 static void
751 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
752 {
753 }
754
755
756 \f
757 /***********************************************************************
758 Display Iterator
759 ***********************************************************************/
760
761 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
762
763 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
764
765
766 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
767 is not contained in the font. */
768
769 static XCharStruct *
770 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
771 XFontStruct *font;
772 XChar2b *char2b;
773 int font_type; /* unused on X */
774 {
775 /* The result metric information. */
776 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
777
778 xassert (font && char2b);
779
780 if (font->per_char != NULL)
781 {
782 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
783 {
784 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
785 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
786 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
787 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
788 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
789 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
790 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
791 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
792 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
793 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
794 }
795 else
796 {
797 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
798 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
799 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
800 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
801
802 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
803 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
804
805 where:
806
807 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
808 / = integer division
809 \ = integer modulus */
810 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
811 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
812 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
813 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
814 {
815 pcm = (font->per_char
816 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
817 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
818 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
819 }
820 }
821 }
822 else
823 {
824 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
825 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
826 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
827 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
828 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
829 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
830 }
831
832 return ((pcm == NULL
833 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
834 ? NULL : pcm);
835 }
836
837
838 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
839 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
840
841 static int
842 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
843 int c;
844 XChar2b *char2b;
845 struct font_info *font_info;
846 int *two_byte_p;
847 {
848 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
849 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
850
851 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
852 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
853 fixed encoding. */
854 if (font_info->font_encoder)
855 {
856 /* It's a program. */
857 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
858
859 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
860 {
861 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
862 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
863 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
864 }
865 else
866 {
867 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
868 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
869 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
870 }
871
872 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
873
874 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
875 program. */
876 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
877 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
878 else
879 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
880 }
881 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
882 {
883 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
884 encoding numbers. */
885 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
886
887 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
888 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
889 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
890
891 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
892 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
893 }
894
895 if (two_byte_p)
896 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
897
898 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
899 }
900
901
902 \f
903 /***********************************************************************
904 Glyph display
905 ***********************************************************************/
906
907
908
909 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
910 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
911 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
912 int));
913 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
914 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
915 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
916 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
917 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
918 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
919 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
920 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
921 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
922 unsigned long *, double, int));
923 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
924 double, int, unsigned long));
925 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
926 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
927 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
928 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
929 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
930 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
931 int, int, int));
932 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
933 int, int, int, int, XRectangle *));
934 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
935 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
936
937 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
938 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
939 #endif
940
941
942 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
943 face. */
944
945 static void
946 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
947 struct glyph_string *s;
948 {
949 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
950 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
951 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
952 && !s->cmp)
953 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
954 else
955 {
956 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
957 XGCValues xgcv;
958 unsigned long mask;
959
960 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
961 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
962
963 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
964 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
965 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
966 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
967 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
968 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
969 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
970
971 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
972 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
973 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
974 {
975 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
976 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
977 }
978
979 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
980 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
981 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
982 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
983
984 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
985 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
986 mask, &xgcv);
987 else
988 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
989 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
990
991 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
992 }
993 }
994
995
996 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
997
998 static void
999 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1000 struct glyph_string *s;
1001 {
1002 int face_id;
1003 struct face *face;
1004
1005 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1006 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1007 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1008 if (face == NULL)
1009 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1010
1011 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1012 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1013 else
1014 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1015 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1016 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1017
1018 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1019 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1020 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1021 else
1022 {
1023 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1024 but font FONT. */
1025 XGCValues xgcv;
1026 unsigned long mask;
1027
1028 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1029 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1030 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1031 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1032 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1033 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1034
1035 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1036 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1037 mask, &xgcv);
1038 else
1039 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1040 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1041
1042 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1043 }
1044
1045 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1046 }
1047
1048
1049 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1050 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1051 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1052
1053 static INLINE void
1054 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1055 struct glyph_string *s;
1056 {
1057 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1058 }
1059
1060
1061 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1062 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1063 pattern. */
1064
1065 static INLINE void
1066 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1067 struct glyph_string *s;
1068 {
1069 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1070
1071 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1072 {
1073 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1074 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1075 }
1076 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1077 {
1078 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1079 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1080 }
1081 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1082 {
1083 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1084 s->stippled_p = 0;
1085 }
1086 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1087 {
1088 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1089 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1090 }
1091 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1092 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1093 {
1094 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1095 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1096 }
1097 else
1098 {
1099 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1100 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1101 }
1102
1103 /* GC must have been set. */
1104 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1105 }
1106
1107
1108 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1109 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1110
1111 static INLINE void
1112 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1113 struct glyph_string *s;
1114 {
1115 XRectangle r;
1116 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1117 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1118 }
1119
1120
1121 /* RIF:
1122 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1123 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1124
1125 static void
1126 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1127 struct glyph_string *s;
1128 {
1129 if (s->cmp == NULL
1130 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1131 {
1132 XCharStruct cs;
1133 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1134 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1135 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1136 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1137 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1138 }
1139 }
1140
1141
1142 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1143
1144 static INLINE void
1145 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1146 struct glyph_string *s;
1147 int x, y, w, h;
1148 {
1149 XGCValues xgcv;
1150 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1151 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1152 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1153 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1154 }
1155
1156
1157 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1158 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1159 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1160 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1161 contains the first component of a composition. */
1162
1163 static void
1164 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1165 struct glyph_string *s;
1166 int force_p;
1167 {
1168 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1169 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1170 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1171 {
1172 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1173
1174 if (s->stippled_p)
1175 {
1176 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1177 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1178 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1179 s->y + box_line_width,
1180 s->background_width,
1181 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1182 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1183 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1184 }
1185 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1186 || s->font_not_found_p
1187 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1188 || force_p)
1189 {
1190 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1191 s->background_width,
1192 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1193 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1194 }
1195 }
1196 }
1197
1198
1199 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1200
1201 static void
1202 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1203 struct glyph_string *s;
1204 {
1205 int i, x;
1206
1207 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1208 of S to the right of that box line. */
1209 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1210 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1211 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1212 else
1213 x = s->x;
1214
1215 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1216 loaded. */
1217 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1218 {
1219 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1220 {
1221 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1222 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1223 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1224 s->height - 1);
1225 x += g->pixel_width;
1226 }
1227 }
1228 else
1229 {
1230 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1231 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1232
1233 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1234 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1235
1236 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1237 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1238 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1239 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1240
1241 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1242 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1243 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1244 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1245 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1246 if (s->for_overlaps_p
1247 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1248 {
1249 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1250 if (s->two_byte_p)
1251 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1252 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1253 else
1254 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1255 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1256 }
1257 else
1258 {
1259 if (s->two_byte_p)
1260 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1261 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1262 else
1263 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1264 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1265 }
1266
1267 if (s->face->overstrike)
1268 {
1269 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1270 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1271 if (s->two_byte_p)
1272 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1273 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1274 else
1275 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1276 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1277 }
1278 }
1279 }
1280
1281 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1282
1283 static void
1284 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1285 struct glyph_string *s;
1286 {
1287 int i, x;
1288
1289 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1290 of S to the right of that box line. */
1291 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1292 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1293 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1294 else
1295 x = s->x;
1296
1297 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1298 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1299 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1300 this composition. */
1301
1302 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1303 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1304 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1305 {
1306 if (s->gidx == 0)
1307 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1308 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1309 }
1310 else
1311 {
1312 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1313 {
1314 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1315 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1316 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1317 s->char2b + i, 1);
1318 if (s->face->overstrike)
1319 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1320 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1321 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1322 s->char2b + i, 1);
1323 }
1324 }
1325 }
1326
1327
1328 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1329
1330 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1331 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1332 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1333 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1334 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1335
1336
1337 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1338 cannot be determined. */
1339
1340 static struct frame *
1341 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1342 Widget widget;
1343 {
1344 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1345 Lisp_Object tail;
1346 struct frame *f;
1347
1348 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1349
1350 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1351 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1352 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1353 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1354 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1355 widget = XtParent (widget);
1356
1357 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1358 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1359 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1360 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1361 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1362 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1363 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1364 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1365 return f;
1366
1367 abort ();
1368 }
1369
1370
1371 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1372 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1373 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1374 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1375
1376 int
1377 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1378 Widget widget;
1379 Colormap cmap;
1380 XColor *color;
1381 {
1382 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1383 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1384 }
1385
1386
1387 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1388 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1389 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1390 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1391 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1392 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1393
1394 int
1395 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1396 Widget widget;
1397 Display *display;
1398 Colormap cmap;
1399 unsigned long *pixel;
1400 double factor;
1401 int delta;
1402 {
1403 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1404 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1405 }
1406
1407
1408 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1409 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1410
1411 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1412 {
1413 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1414 sizeof (Screen *)},
1415 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1416 sizeof (Colormap)}
1417 };
1418
1419
1420 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1421 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1422
1423 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1424
1425
1426 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1427
1428 DPY is the display we are working on.
1429
1430 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1431 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1432 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1433 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1434
1435 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1436 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1437
1438 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1439 we allocated the color or not.
1440
1441 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1442
1443 static Boolean
1444 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1445 Display *dpy;
1446 XrmValue *args;
1447 Cardinal *nargs;
1448 XrmValue *from, *to;
1449 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1450 {
1451 Screen *screen;
1452 Colormap cmap;
1453 Pixel pixel;
1454 String color_name;
1455 XColor color;
1456
1457 if (*nargs != 2)
1458 {
1459 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1460 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1461 "XtToolkitError",
1462 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1463 return False;
1464 }
1465
1466 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1467 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1468 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1469
1470 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1471 {
1472 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1473 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1474 }
1475 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1476 {
1477 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1478 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1479 }
1480 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1481 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1482 {
1483 pixel = color.pixel;
1484 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1485 }
1486 else
1487 {
1488 String params[1];
1489 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1490
1491 params[0] = color_name;
1492 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1493 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1494 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1495 params, &nparams);
1496 return False;
1497 }
1498
1499 if (to->addr != NULL)
1500 {
1501 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1502 {
1503 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1504 return False;
1505 }
1506
1507 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1508 }
1509 else
1510 {
1511 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1512 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1513 }
1514
1515 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1516 return True;
1517 }
1518
1519
1520 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1521 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1522 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1523
1524 APP is the application context in which we work.
1525
1526 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1527 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1528 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1529
1530 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1531
1532 static void
1533 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1534 XtAppContext app;
1535 XrmValuePtr to;
1536 XtPointer closure;
1537 XrmValuePtr args;
1538 Cardinal *nargs;
1539 {
1540 if (*nargs != 2)
1541 {
1542 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1543 "XtToolkitError",
1544 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1545 NULL, NULL);
1546 }
1547 else if (closure != NULL)
1548 {
1549 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1550 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1551 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1552 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1553 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1554 }
1555 }
1556
1557
1558 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1559
1560
1561 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1562 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1563 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1564 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1565
1566 static const XColor *
1567 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1568 Display *dpy;
1569 int *ncells;
1570 {
1571 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1572
1573 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1574 {
1575 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1576 int i;
1577
1578 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1579 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1580 dpyinfo->color_cells
1581 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1582 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1583
1584 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1585 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1586
1587 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1588 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1589 }
1590
1591 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1592 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1593 }
1594
1595
1596 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1597 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1598
1599 void
1600 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1601 struct frame *f;
1602 XColor *colors;
1603 int ncolors;
1604 {
1605 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1606
1607 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1608 {
1609 int i;
1610 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1611 {
1612 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1613 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1614 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1615 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1616 }
1617 }
1618 else
1619 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1620 }
1621
1622
1623 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1624 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1625
1626 void
1627 x_query_color (f, color)
1628 struct frame *f;
1629 XColor *color;
1630 {
1631 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1632 }
1633
1634
1635 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1636 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1637 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1638 allocated. */
1639
1640 static int
1641 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1642 Display *dpy;
1643 Colormap cmap;
1644 XColor *color;
1645 {
1646 int rc;
1647
1648 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1649 if (rc == 0)
1650 {
1651 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1652 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1653 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1654 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1655 int nearest, i;
1656 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1657 int ncells;
1658 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1659
1660 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1661 {
1662 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1663 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1664 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1665 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1666
1667 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1668 {
1669 nearest = i;
1670 nearest_delta = delta;
1671 }
1672 }
1673
1674 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1675 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1676 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1677 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1678 }
1679 else
1680 {
1681 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1682 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1683 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1684 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1685 XColor *cached_color;
1686
1687 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1688 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1689 (cached_color->red != color->red
1690 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1691 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1692 {
1693 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1694 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1695 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1696 }
1697 }
1698
1699 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1700 if (rc)
1701 register_color (color->pixel);
1702 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1703
1704 return rc;
1705 }
1706
1707
1708 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1709 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1710 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1711 allocated. */
1712
1713 int
1714 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1715 struct frame *f;
1716 Colormap cmap;
1717 XColor *color;
1718 {
1719 gamma_correct (f, color);
1720 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1721 }
1722
1723
1724 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1725 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1726 get color reference counts right. */
1727
1728 unsigned long
1729 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1730 struct frame *f;
1731 unsigned long pixel;
1732 {
1733 XColor color;
1734
1735 color.pixel = pixel;
1736 BLOCK_INPUT;
1737 x_query_color (f, &color);
1738 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1739 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1740 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1741 register_color (pixel);
1742 #endif
1743 return color.pixel;
1744 }
1745
1746
1747 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1748 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1749 get color reference counts right. */
1750
1751 unsigned long
1752 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1753 Display *dpy;
1754 Colormap cmap;
1755 unsigned long pixel;
1756 {
1757 XColor color;
1758
1759 color.pixel = pixel;
1760 BLOCK_INPUT;
1761 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1762 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1763 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1764 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1765 register_color (pixel);
1766 #endif
1767 return color.pixel;
1768 }
1769
1770
1771 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1772 boosted.
1773
1774 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1775 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1776 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1777 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1778 use an additional additive factor.
1779
1780 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1781 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1782 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1783
1784
1785 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1786 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1787 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1788 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1789 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1790 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1791
1792 static int
1793 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1794 struct frame *f;
1795 Display *display;
1796 Colormap cmap;
1797 unsigned long *pixel;
1798 double factor;
1799 int delta;
1800 {
1801 XColor color, new;
1802 long bright;
1803 int success_p;
1804
1805 /* Get RGB color values. */
1806 color.pixel = *pixel;
1807 x_query_color (f, &color);
1808
1809 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1810 xassert (factor >= 0);
1811 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1812 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1813 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1814
1815 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1816 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1817
1818 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1819 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1820 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1821 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1822 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1823 {
1824 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1825 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1826 /* The additive adjustment. */
1827 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1828
1829 if (factor < 1)
1830 {
1831 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1832 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1833 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1834 }
1835 else
1836 {
1837 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1838 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1839 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1840 }
1841 }
1842
1843 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1844 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1845 if (success_p)
1846 {
1847 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1848 {
1849 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1850 delta to the RGB values. */
1851 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1852
1853 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1854 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1855 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1856 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1857 }
1858 else
1859 success_p = 1;
1860 *pixel = new.pixel;
1861 }
1862
1863 return success_p;
1864 }
1865
1866
1867 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1868 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1869 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1870 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1871 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1872 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1873
1874 static void
1875 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1876 struct frame *f;
1877 struct relief *relief;
1878 double factor;
1879 int delta;
1880 unsigned long default_pixel;
1881 {
1882 XGCValues xgcv;
1883 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1884 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1885 unsigned long pixel;
1886 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1887 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1888 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1889 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1890
1891 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1892 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1893
1894 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1895 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1896 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1897 if (relief->gc
1898 && relief->allocated_p)
1899 {
1900 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1901 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1902 }
1903
1904 /* Allocate new color. */
1905 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1906 pixel = background;
1907 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1908 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1909 {
1910 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1911 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1912 }
1913
1914 if (relief->gc == 0)
1915 {
1916 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1917 mask |= GCStipple;
1918 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1919 }
1920 else
1921 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1922 }
1923
1924
1925 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1926
1927 static void
1928 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1929 struct glyph_string *s;
1930 {
1931 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1932 unsigned long color;
1933
1934 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1935 color = s->face->box_color;
1936 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1937 && s->img->pixmap
1938 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1939 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1940 else
1941 {
1942 XGCValues xgcv;
1943
1944 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1945 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1946 color = xgcv.background;
1947 }
1948
1949 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1950 || color != di->relief_background)
1951 {
1952 di->relief_background = color;
1953 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1954 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1955 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1956 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1957 }
1958 }
1959
1960
1961 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1962 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1963 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1964 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1965 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1966 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1967 when drawing. */
1968
1969 static void
1970 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
1971 raised_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
1972 struct frame *f;
1973 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
1974 XRectangle *clip_rect;
1975 {
1976 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1977 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1978 int i;
1979 GC gc;
1980
1981 if (raised_p)
1982 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1983 else
1984 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1985 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1986
1987 /* Top. */
1988 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
1989 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1990 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
1991 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
1992
1993 /* Left. */
1994 if (left_p)
1995 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
1996 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1997 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
1998
1999 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2000 if (raised_p)
2001 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2002 else
2003 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2004 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2005
2006 /* Bottom. */
2007 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2008 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2009 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2010 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2011
2012 /* Right. */
2013 if (right_p)
2014 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2015 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2016 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2017
2018 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2019 }
2020
2021
2022 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2023 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2024 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2025 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2026 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2027 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2028
2029 static void
2030 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2031 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2032 struct glyph_string *s;
2033 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2034 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2035 {
2036 XGCValues xgcv;
2037
2038 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2039 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2040 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2041
2042 /* Top. */
2043 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2044 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2045
2046 /* Left. */
2047 if (left_p)
2048 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2049 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2050
2051 /* Bottom. */
2052 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2053 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2054
2055 /* Right. */
2056 if (right_p)
2057 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2058 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2059
2060 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2061 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2062 }
2063
2064
2065 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2066
2067 static void
2068 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2069 struct glyph_string *s;
2070 {
2071 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2072 int left_p, right_p;
2073 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2074 XRectangle clip_rect;
2075
2076 last_x = window_box_right (s->w, s->area);
2077 if (s->row->full_width_p
2078 && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2079 {
2080 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (s->w);
2081 if (s->area != RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA
2082 || WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (s->w))
2083 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (s->w);
2084 }
2085
2086 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2087 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2088 ? s->first_glyph
2089 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2090
2091 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2092 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2093 left_x = s->x;
2094 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2095 ? last_x - 1
2096 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2097 top_y = s->y;
2098 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2099
2100 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2101 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2102 && (s->prev == NULL
2103 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2104 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2105 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2106 && (s->next == NULL
2107 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2108
2109 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2110
2111 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2112 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2113 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2114 else
2115 {
2116 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2117 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2118 width, raised_p, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2119 }
2120 }
2121
2122
2123 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2124
2125 static void
2126 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2127 struct glyph_string *s;
2128 {
2129 int x;
2130 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
2131
2132 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2133 right of that line. */
2134 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2135 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2136 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2137 else
2138 x = s->x;
2139
2140 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2141 by that margin. */
2142 x += s->img->hmargin;
2143 y += s->img->vmargin;
2144
2145 if (s->img->pixmap)
2146 {
2147 if (s->img->mask)
2148 {
2149 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2150 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2151 trust on the shape extension to be available
2152 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2153 manually. */
2154 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2155 | GCFunction);
2156 XGCValues xgcv;
2157 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2158
2159 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2160 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2161 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2162 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2163 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2164
2165 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2166 image_rect.x = x;
2167 image_rect.y = y;
2168 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
2169 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
2170 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2171 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2172 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2173 }
2174 else
2175 {
2176 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2177
2178 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2179 image_rect.x = x;
2180 image_rect.y = y;
2181 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
2182 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
2183 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2184 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2185 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2186
2187 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2188 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2189 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2190 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2191 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2192 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2193 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2194 {
2195 int r = s->img->relief;
2196 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2197 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2198 s->img->width + r*2 - 1, s->img->height + r*2 - 1);
2199 }
2200 }
2201 }
2202 else
2203 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2204 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2205 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
2206 }
2207
2208
2209 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2210
2211 static void
2212 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2213 struct glyph_string *s;
2214 {
2215 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2216 XRectangle r;
2217 int x;
2218 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
2219
2220 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2221 right of that line. */
2222 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2223 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2224 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2225 else
2226 x = s->x;
2227
2228 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2229 by that margin. */
2230 x += s->img->hmargin;
2231 y += s->img->vmargin;
2232
2233 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2234 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2235 {
2236 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2237 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2238 }
2239 else
2240 {
2241 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2242 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2243 }
2244
2245 x0 = x - thick;
2246 y0 = y - thick;
2247 x1 = x + s->img->width + thick - 1;
2248 y1 = y + s->img->height + thick - 1;
2249
2250 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2251 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2252 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, 1, 1, &r);
2253 }
2254
2255
2256 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2257
2258 static void
2259 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2260 struct glyph_string *s;
2261 Pixmap pixmap;
2262 {
2263 int x;
2264 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
2265
2266 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2267 right of that line. */
2268 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2269 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2270 x = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2271 else
2272 x = 0;
2273
2274 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2275 by that margin. */
2276 x += s->img->hmargin;
2277 y += s->img->vmargin;
2278
2279 if (s->img->pixmap)
2280 {
2281 if (s->img->mask)
2282 {
2283 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2284 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2285 trust on the shape extension to be available
2286 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2287 manually. */
2288 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2289 | GCFunction);
2290 XGCValues xgcv;
2291
2292 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2293 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2294 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2295 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2296 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2297
2298 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2299 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
2300 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2301 }
2302 else
2303 {
2304 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2305 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
2306
2307 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2308 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2309 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2310 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2311 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2312 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2313 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2314 {
2315 int r = s->img->relief;
2316 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2317 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2318 s->img->width + r*2 - 1, s->img->height + r*2 - 1);
2319 }
2320 }
2321 }
2322 else
2323 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2324 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2325 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
2326 }
2327
2328
2329 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2330 give the rectangle to draw. */
2331
2332 static void
2333 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2334 struct glyph_string *s;
2335 int x, y, w, h;
2336 {
2337 if (s->stippled_p)
2338 {
2339 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2340 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2341 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2342 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2343 }
2344 else
2345 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2346 }
2347
2348
2349 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2350
2351 s->y
2352 s->x +-------------------------
2353 | s->face->box
2354 |
2355 | +-------------------------
2356 | | s->img->margin
2357 | |
2358 | | +-------------------
2359 | | | the image
2360
2361 */
2362
2363 static void
2364 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2365 struct glyph_string *s;
2366 {
2367 int x, y;
2368 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2369 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2370 int height;
2371 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2372
2373 height = s->height - 2 * box_line_vwidth;
2374
2375
2376 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2377 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2378 flickering. */
2379 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2380 if (height > s->img->height
2381 || s->img->hmargin
2382 || s->img->vmargin
2383 || s->img->mask
2384 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2385 || s->width != s->background_width)
2386 {
2387 if (box_line_hwidth && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2388 x = s->x + box_line_hwidth;
2389 else
2390 x = s->x;
2391
2392 y = s->y + box_line_vwidth;
2393
2394 if (s->img->mask)
2395 {
2396 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2397 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2398 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2399 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2400 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2401
2402 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2403 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2404 s->background_width,
2405 s->height, depth);
2406
2407 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2408 pixmap. */
2409 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2410
2411 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2412 if (s->stippled_p)
2413 {
2414 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2415 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2416 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2417 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2418 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2419 }
2420 else
2421 {
2422 XGCValues xgcv;
2423 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2424 &xgcv);
2425 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2426 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2427 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2428 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2429 }
2430 }
2431 else
2432 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2433
2434 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2435 }
2436
2437 /* Draw the foreground. */
2438 if (pixmap != None)
2439 {
2440 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2441 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2442 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2443 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2444 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2445 }
2446 else
2447 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2448
2449 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2450 if (s->img->relief
2451 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2452 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2453 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2454 }
2455
2456
2457 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2458
2459 static void
2460 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2461 struct glyph_string *s;
2462 {
2463 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2464 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2465
2466 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2467 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2468 {
2469 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2470 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2471 int width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), s->background_width);
2472
2473 /* Draw cursor. */
2474 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
2475
2476 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2477 if (width < s->background_width)
2478 {
2479 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
2480 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
2481 XRectangle r;
2482 GC gc;
2483
2484 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2485 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2486 {
2487 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2488 gc = s->gc;
2489 }
2490 else
2491 gc = s->face->gc;
2492
2493 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2494 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2495
2496 if (s->face->stipple)
2497 {
2498 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2499 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2500 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2501 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2502 }
2503 else
2504 {
2505 XGCValues xgcv;
2506 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2507 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2508 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2509 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2510 }
2511 }
2512 }
2513 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2514 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
2515 s->height);
2516
2517 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2518 }
2519
2520
2521 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2522
2523 static void
2524 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2525 struct glyph_string *s;
2526 {
2527 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2528
2529 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2530 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2531 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2532 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps_p)
2533 {
2534 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2535 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2536 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2537 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2538 }
2539
2540 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2541 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2542
2543 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2544 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2545 if (!s->for_overlaps_p
2546 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2547 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2548 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2549
2550 {
2551 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2552 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2553 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2554 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2555 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2556 }
2557 else
2558 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2559
2560 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2561 {
2562 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2563 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2564 break;
2565
2566 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2567 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2568 break;
2569
2570 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2571 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
2572 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2573 else
2574 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2575 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2576 break;
2577
2578 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2579 if (s->for_overlaps_p || s->gidx > 0)
2580 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2581 else
2582 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2583 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2584 break;
2585
2586 default:
2587 abort ();
2588 }
2589
2590 if (!s->for_overlaps_p)
2591 {
2592 /* Draw underline. */
2593 if (s->face->underline_p)
2594 {
2595 unsigned long tem, h;
2596 int y;
2597
2598 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2599 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2600 h = 1;
2601
2602 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2603 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2604 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2605 specs, and its default is
2606
2607 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2608 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2609
2610 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2611 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2612 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2613 else if (s->face->font)
2614 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2615 else
2616 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2617
2618 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2619 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2620 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2621 else
2622 {
2623 XGCValues xgcv;
2624 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2625 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2626 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2627 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2628 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2629 }
2630 }
2631
2632 /* Draw overline. */
2633 if (s->face->overline_p)
2634 {
2635 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2636
2637 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2638 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2639 s->width, h);
2640 else
2641 {
2642 XGCValues xgcv;
2643 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2644 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2645 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2646 s->width, h);
2647 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2648 }
2649 }
2650
2651 /* Draw strike-through. */
2652 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2653 {
2654 unsigned long h = 1;
2655 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2656
2657 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2658 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2659 s->width, h);
2660 else
2661 {
2662 XGCValues xgcv;
2663 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2664 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2665 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2666 s->width, h);
2667 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2668 }
2669 }
2670
2671 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2672 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2673 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2674 }
2675
2676 /* Reset clipping. */
2677 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2678 }
2679
2680 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2681
2682 void
2683 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2684 struct frame *f;
2685 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2686 {
2687 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2688 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2689 x, y, width, height,
2690 x + shift_by, y);
2691 }
2692
2693 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2694 for X frames. */
2695
2696 static void
2697 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2698 register int n;
2699 {
2700 abort ();
2701 }
2702
2703
2704 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2705 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2706
2707 void
2708 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2709 Display *dpy;
2710 Window window;
2711 int x, y;
2712 int width, height;
2713 int exposures;
2714 {
2715 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2716 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2717 }
2718
2719
2720 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2721 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2722
2723 static void
2724 x_clear_frame ()
2725 {
2726 struct frame *f;
2727
2728 if (updating_frame)
2729 f = updating_frame;
2730 else
2731 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2732
2733 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2734 longer visible. */
2735 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2736 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2737 output_cursor.x = -1;
2738
2739 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2740 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2741 BLOCK_INPUT;
2742 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2743
2744 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2745 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2746 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2747
2748 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2749
2750 #ifdef USE_GTK
2751 xg_frame_cleared (f);
2752 #endif
2753
2754 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2755 }
2756
2757
2758 \f
2759 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2760
2761 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2762 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2763
2764 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2765
2766
2767 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2768 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2769
2770 static int
2771 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2772 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2773 {
2774 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2775 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2776 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2777 {
2778 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2779 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2780 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2781 }
2782
2783 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2784 {
2785 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2786 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2787 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2788 }
2789
2790 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2791 positive. */
2792 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2793 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2794
2795 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2796 negative. */
2797 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2798 }
2799
2800 void
2801 XTflash (f)
2802 struct frame *f;
2803 {
2804 BLOCK_INPUT;
2805
2806 {
2807 GC gc;
2808
2809 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2810 pixels into background pixels. */
2811 {
2812 XGCValues values;
2813
2814 values.function = GXxor;
2815 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2816 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2817
2818 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2819 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2820 }
2821
2822 {
2823 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2824 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2825 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2826 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2827 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2828 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2829 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2830
2831 int width;
2832
2833 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2834 edge it is next to. */
2835 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2836 {
2837 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2838 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2839 break;
2840
2841 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2842 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2843 break;
2844
2845 default:
2846 break;
2847 }
2848
2849 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2850
2851 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2852 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2853 {
2854 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2855 flash_left,
2856 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2857 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2858 width, flash_height);
2859 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2860 flash_left,
2861 (height - flash_height
2862 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2863 width, flash_height);
2864 }
2865 else
2866 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2867 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2868 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2869 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2870
2871 x_flush (f);
2872
2873 {
2874 struct timeval wakeup;
2875
2876 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2877
2878 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2879 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2880 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2881 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2882
2883 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2884 available. */
2885 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2886 {
2887 struct timeval current;
2888 struct timeval timeout;
2889
2890 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2891
2892 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2893 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2894 break;
2895
2896 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2897 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2898 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2899
2900 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2901 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2902 }
2903 }
2904
2905 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2906 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2907 {
2908 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2909 flash_left,
2910 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2911 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2912 width, flash_height);
2913 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2914 flash_left,
2915 (height - flash_height
2916 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2917 width, flash_height);
2918 }
2919 else
2920 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2921 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2922 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2923 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2924
2925 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
2926 x_flush (f);
2927 }
2928 }
2929
2930 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2931 }
2932
2933 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
2934
2935
2936 /* Make audible bell. */
2937
2938 void
2939 XTring_bell ()
2940 {
2941 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2942
2943 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
2944 {
2945 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2946 if (visible_bell)
2947 XTflash (f);
2948 else
2949 #endif
2950 {
2951 BLOCK_INPUT;
2952 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
2953 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2954 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2955 }
2956 }
2957 }
2958
2959 \f
2960 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
2961 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
2962 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
2963 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
2964
2965 static void
2966 XTset_terminal_window (n)
2967 register int n;
2968 {
2969 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
2970 }
2971
2972
2973 \f
2974 /***********************************************************************
2975 Line Dance
2976 ***********************************************************************/
2977
2978 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
2979 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
2980
2981 static void
2982 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
2983 int vpos, n;
2984 {
2985 abort ();
2986 }
2987
2988
2989 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
2990
2991 static void
2992 x_scroll_run (w, run)
2993 struct window *w;
2994 struct run *run;
2995 {
2996 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
2997 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
2998
2999 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3000 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3001 fringe of W. */
3002 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3003
3004 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3005 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3006 bottom_y = y + height;
3007
3008 if (to_y < from_y)
3009 {
3010 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3011 line at the bottom. */
3012 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3013 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3014 else
3015 height = run->height;
3016 }
3017 else
3018 {
3019 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3020 at the bottom. */
3021 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3022 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3023 else
3024 height = run->height;
3025 }
3026
3027 BLOCK_INPUT;
3028
3029 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3030 updated_window = w;
3031 x_clear_cursor (w);
3032
3033 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3034 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3035 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3036 x, from_y,
3037 width, height,
3038 x, to_y);
3039
3040 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3041 }
3042
3043
3044 \f
3045 /***********************************************************************
3046 Exposure Events
3047 ***********************************************************************/
3048
3049 \f
3050 static void
3051 frame_highlight (f)
3052 struct frame *f;
3053 {
3054 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3055 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3056 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3057 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3058 BLOCK_INPUT;
3059 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3060 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3061 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3062 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3063 }
3064
3065 static void
3066 frame_unhighlight (f)
3067 struct frame *f;
3068 {
3069 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3070 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3071 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3072 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3073 BLOCK_INPUT;
3074 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3075 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3076 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3077 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3078 }
3079
3080 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3081 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3082 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3083 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3084 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3085
3086 static void
3087 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3088 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3089 struct frame *frame;
3090 {
3091 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3092
3093 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3094 {
3095 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3096 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3097 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3098
3099 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3100 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3101
3102 #if 0
3103 selected_frame = frame;
3104 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3105 selected_frame);
3106 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3107 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3108 #endif /* ! 0 */
3109
3110 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3111 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3112 else
3113 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3114 }
3115
3116 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3117 }
3118
3119 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3120 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3121 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into BUFP.
3122 Returns number of events inserted into BUFP. */
3123
3124 static int
3125 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp, numchars)
3126 int type;
3127 int state;
3128 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3129 struct frame *frame;
3130 struct input_event *bufp;
3131 int numchars;
3132 {
3133 int nr_events = 0;
3134
3135 if (type == FocusIn)
3136 {
3137 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3138 {
3139 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3140 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3141
3142 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3143 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3144 if (numchars > 0
3145 && GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3146 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3147 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3148 {
3149 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3150 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3151 bufp->arg = Qnil;
3152 ++bufp;
3153 numchars--;
3154 ++nr_events;
3155 }
3156 }
3157
3158 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3159
3160 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3161 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3162 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3163 #endif
3164 }
3165 else if (type == FocusOut)
3166 {
3167 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3168
3169 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3170 {
3171 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3172 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3173 }
3174
3175 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3176 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3177 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3178 #endif
3179 }
3180
3181 return nr_events;
3182 }
3183
3184 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3185 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3186
3187 Returns number of events inserted into BUFP. */
3188
3189 static int
3190 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp, numchars)
3191 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3192 XEvent *event;
3193 struct input_event *bufp;
3194 int numchars;
3195 {
3196 struct frame *frame;
3197 int nr_events = 0;
3198
3199 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3200 if (! frame) return nr_events;
3201
3202 switch (event->type)
3203 {
3204 case EnterNotify:
3205 case LeaveNotify:
3206 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3207 && event->xcrossing.focus
3208 && ! (frame->output_data.x->focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3209 nr_events = x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify
3210 ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3211 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3212 dpyinfo,
3213 frame,
3214 bufp,
3215 numchars);
3216 break;
3217
3218 case FocusIn:
3219 case FocusOut:
3220 nr_events = x_focus_changed (event->type,
3221 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer
3222 ? FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3223 dpyinfo,
3224 frame,
3225 bufp,
3226 numchars);
3227 break;
3228 }
3229
3230 return nr_events;
3231 }
3232
3233
3234 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3235
3236 void
3237 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3238 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3239 {
3240 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3241 }
3242
3243 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3244 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3245 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3246
3247 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3248 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3249 the appropriate X display info. */
3250
3251 static void
3252 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3253 struct frame *frame;
3254 {
3255 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3256 }
3257
3258 static void
3259 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3260 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3261 {
3262 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3263
3264 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3265 {
3266 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3267 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3268 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3269 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3270 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3271 {
3272 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3273 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3274 }
3275 }
3276 else
3277 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3278
3279 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3280 {
3281 if (old_highlight)
3282 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3283 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3284 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3285 }
3286 }
3287
3288
3289 \f
3290 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3291
3292 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3293 static void
3294 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3295 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3296 {
3297 int min_code, max_code;
3298 KeySym *syms;
3299 int syms_per_code;
3300 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3301
3302 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3303 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3304 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3305 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3306 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3307
3308 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3309 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3310 #else
3311 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3312 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3313 #endif
3314
3315 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3316 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3317 &syms_per_code);
3318 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3319
3320 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3321 Alt keysyms are on. */
3322 {
3323 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3324
3325 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3326 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3327 {
3328 KeyCode code
3329 = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3330
3331 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3332 if (code == 0)
3333 continue;
3334
3335 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3336 {
3337 int code_col;
3338
3339 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3340 {
3341 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3342
3343 switch (sym)
3344 {
3345 case XK_Meta_L:
3346 case XK_Meta_R:
3347 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3348 break;
3349
3350 case XK_Alt_L:
3351 case XK_Alt_R:
3352 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3353 break;
3354
3355 case XK_Hyper_L:
3356 case XK_Hyper_R:
3357 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3358 break;
3359
3360 case XK_Super_L:
3361 case XK_Super_R:
3362 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3363 break;
3364
3365 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3366 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3367 if ((1 << row) == LockMask)
3368 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3369 break;
3370 }
3371 }
3372 }
3373 }
3374 }
3375
3376 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3377 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3378 {
3379 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3380 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3381 }
3382
3383 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3384 make them just meta, not alt. */
3385 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3386 {
3387 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3388 }
3389
3390 XFree ((char *) syms);
3391 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3392 }
3393
3394 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3395 Emacs uses. */
3396
3397 static unsigned int
3398 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3399 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3400 unsigned int state;
3401 {
3402 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3403 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3404 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3405 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3406 Lisp_Object tem;
3407
3408 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3409 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3410 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3411 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3412 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3413 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3414 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3415 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3416
3417
3418 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3419 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3420 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3421 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3422 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3423 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3424 }
3425
3426 static unsigned int
3427 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3428 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3429 unsigned int state;
3430 {
3431 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3432 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3433 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3434 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3435
3436 Lisp_Object tem;
3437
3438 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3439 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3440 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3441 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3442 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3443 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3444 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3445 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3446
3447
3448 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3449 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3450 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3451 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3452 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3453 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3454 }
3455
3456 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3457
3458 char *
3459 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3460 KeySym keysym;
3461 {
3462 char *value;
3463
3464 BLOCK_INPUT;
3465 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3466 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3467
3468 return value;
3469 }
3470
3471
3472 \f
3473 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3474
3475 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3476
3477 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3478 the mouse. */
3479
3480 static Lisp_Object
3481 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3482 struct input_event *result;
3483 XButtonEvent *event;
3484 struct frame *f;
3485 {
3486 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3487 otherwise. */
3488 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3489 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3490 result->timestamp = event->time;
3491 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3492 event->state)
3493 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3494 ? up_modifier
3495 : down_modifier));
3496
3497 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3498 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3499 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3500 result->arg = Qnil;
3501 return Qnil;
3502 }
3503
3504 \f
3505 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3506 The input handler calls this.
3507
3508 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3509 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3510 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3511 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3512
3513 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3514 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3515
3516 static void
3517 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3518 FRAME_PTR frame;
3519 XMotionEvent *event;
3520 {
3521 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3522 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3523 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3524
3525 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3526 {
3527 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3528 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3529 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3530 }
3531
3532 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3533 else if (event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3534 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3535 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3536 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3537 {
3538 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3539 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3540 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3541 }
3542 }
3543
3544 \f
3545 /************************************************************************
3546 Mouse Face
3547 ************************************************************************/
3548
3549 static void
3550 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3551 {
3552 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3553 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3554 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3555 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3556 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3557 }
3558
3559
3560 static int glyph_rect P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int, XRectangle *));
3561
3562
3563 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
3564 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F . Return the position and
3565 size in *RECT. Value is non-zero if we could compute these
3566 values. */
3567
3568 static int
3569 glyph_rect (f, x, y, rect)
3570 struct frame *f;
3571 int x, y;
3572 XRectangle *rect;
3573 {
3574 Lisp_Object window;
3575 int found = 0;
3576
3577 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, &x, &y, 0);
3578 if (!NILP (window))
3579 {
3580 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
3581 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
3582 struct glyph_row *end = r + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1;
3583
3584 for (; !found && r < end && r->enabled_p; ++r)
3585 if (r->y >= y)
3586 {
3587 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
3588 struct glyph *end = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
3589 int gx;
3590
3591 for (gx = r->x; !found && g < end; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
3592 if (gx >= x)
3593 {
3594 rect->width = g->pixel_width;
3595 rect->height = r->height;
3596 rect->x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, gx);
3597 rect->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, r->y);
3598 found = 1;
3599 }
3600 }
3601 }
3602
3603 return found;
3604 }
3605
3606
3607 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3608 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3609
3610 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3611 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3612 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3613 position on the scroll bar.
3614
3615 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3616 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3617 the mouse is over.
3618
3619 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3620 was at this position.
3621
3622 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3623
3624 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3625 movement. */
3626
3627 static void
3628 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3629 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3630 int insist;
3631 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3632 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3633 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3634 unsigned long *time;
3635 {
3636 FRAME_PTR f1;
3637
3638 BLOCK_INPUT;
3639
3640 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3641 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3642 else
3643 {
3644 Window root;
3645 int root_x, root_y;
3646
3647 Window dummy_window;
3648 int dummy;
3649
3650 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3651
3652 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3653 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3654 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3655 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3656
3657 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3658
3659 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3660 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3661 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3662
3663 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3664 &root,
3665
3666 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3667 a different screen. */
3668 &dummy_window,
3669
3670 /* The position on that root window. */
3671 &root_x, &root_y,
3672
3673 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3674 &dummy, &dummy,
3675
3676 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3677 we don't care. */
3678 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3679
3680 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3681 containing the pointer. */
3682 {
3683 Window win, child;
3684 int win_x, win_y;
3685 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3686 int count;
3687
3688 win = root;
3689
3690 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3691 structure is changing at the same time this function
3692 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3693
3694 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3695
3696 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3697 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3698 {
3699 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3700 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3701 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3702
3703 /* From-window, to-window. */
3704 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3705
3706 /* From-position, to-position. */
3707 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3708
3709 /* Child of win. */
3710 &child);
3711 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3712 }
3713 else
3714 {
3715 while (1)
3716 {
3717 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3718
3719 /* From-window, to-window. */
3720 root, win,
3721
3722 /* From-position, to-position. */
3723 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3724
3725 /* Child of win. */
3726 &child);
3727
3728 if (child == None || child == win)
3729 break;
3730
3731 win = child;
3732 parent_x = win_x;
3733 parent_y = win_y;
3734 }
3735
3736 /* Now we know that:
3737 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3738 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3739 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3740 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3741 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3742 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3743 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3744 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3745 never use them in that case.) */
3746
3747 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3748 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3749
3750 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3751 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3752 on the frame. */
3753 if (f1 != NULL
3754 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3755 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3756 f1 = NULL;
3757 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3758 }
3759
3760 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3761 f1 = 0;
3762
3763 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), count);
3764
3765 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3766 if (! f1)
3767 {
3768 struct scroll_bar *bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (win);
3769
3770 if (bar)
3771 {
3772 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3773 win_x = parent_x;
3774 win_y = parent_y;
3775 }
3776 }
3777
3778 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3779 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3780
3781 if (f1)
3782 {
3783 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3784 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3785 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3786 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3787 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3788 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3789 the frame are divided into. */
3790
3791 int width, height, gx, gy;
3792 XRectangle rect;
3793
3794 if (glyph_rect (f1, win_x, win_y, &rect))
3795 last_mouse_glyph = rect;
3796 else
3797 {
3798 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f1);
3799 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f1);
3800 gx = win_x;
3801 gy = win_y;
3802
3803 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
3804 round down even for negative values. */
3805 if (gx < 0)
3806 gx -= width - 1;
3807 if (gy < 0)
3808 gy -= height - 1;
3809 gx = (gx + width - 1) / width * width;
3810 gy = (gy + height - 1) / height * height;
3811
3812 last_mouse_glyph.width = width;
3813 last_mouse_glyph.height = height;
3814 last_mouse_glyph.x = gx;
3815 last_mouse_glyph.y = gy;
3816 }
3817
3818 *bar_window = Qnil;
3819 *part = 0;
3820 *fp = f1;
3821 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3822 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3823 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3824 }
3825 }
3826 }
3827
3828 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3829 }
3830
3831
3832 \f
3833 /***********************************************************************
3834 Scroll bars
3835 ***********************************************************************/
3836
3837 /* Scroll bar support. */
3838
3839 /* Given an X window ID, find the struct scroll_bar which manages it.
3840 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3841 bits. */
3842
3843 static struct scroll_bar *
3844 x_window_to_scroll_bar (window_id)
3845 Window window_id;
3846 {
3847 Lisp_Object tail;
3848
3849 #ifdef USE_GTK
3850 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (window_id);
3851 #endif /* USE_GTK */
3852
3853 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3854 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3855 tail = XCDR (tail))
3856 {
3857 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3858
3859 frame = XCAR (tail);
3860 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3861 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3862 abort ();
3863
3864 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3865 right window ID. */
3866 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3867 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3868 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3869 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3870 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3871 condemned = Qnil,
3872 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3873 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3874 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id)
3875 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3876 }
3877
3878 return 0;
3879 }
3880
3881
3882 #if defined USE_LUCID
3883
3884 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3885 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3886
3887 static Widget
3888 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3889 Window window;
3890 {
3891 Lisp_Object tail;
3892
3893 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3894 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3895 tail = XCDR (tail))
3896 {
3897 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3898 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3899
3900 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3901 return menu_bar;
3902 }
3903
3904 return NULL;
3905 }
3906
3907 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3908
3909 \f
3910 /************************************************************************
3911 Toolkit scroll bars
3912 ************************************************************************/
3913
3914 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3915
3916 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3917 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3918 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3919 struct scroll_bar *));
3920 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
3921 int, int, int));
3922
3923
3924 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
3925 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
3926
3927 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
3928
3929 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
3930
3931 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
3932
3933 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
3934 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
3935
3936 #ifndef USE_GTK
3937 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
3938
3939 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
3940
3941 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
3942
3943 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
3944 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
3945 to avoid jerkyness. */
3946
3947 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
3948
3949 extern void set_vertical_scroll_bar P_ ((struct window *));
3950
3951 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
3952 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
3953 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
3954 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
3955
3956 static void
3957 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
3958 num_params)
3959 Widget widget;
3960 XtPointer client_data;
3961 String action_name;
3962 XEvent *event;
3963 String *params;
3964 Cardinal *num_params;
3965 {
3966 int scroll_bar_p;
3967 char *end_action;
3968
3969 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
3970 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
3971 end_action = "Release";
3972 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
3973 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
3974 end_action = "EndScroll";
3975 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
3976
3977 if (scroll_bar_p
3978 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
3979 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
3980 {
3981 struct window *w;
3982
3983 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
3984 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
3985 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
3986
3987 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
3988 {
3989 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
3990 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
3991 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
3992 }
3993 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
3994 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
3995
3996 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
3997 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
3998 }
3999 }
4000 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4001
4002 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4003 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4004
4005 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4006 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4007
4008
4009 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4010 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4011 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4012 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4013
4014 static void
4015 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4016 Lisp_Object window;
4017 int part, portion, whole;
4018 {
4019 XEvent event;
4020 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4021 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4022 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4023 int i;
4024
4025 BLOCK_INPUT;
4026
4027 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4028 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4029 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4030 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4031 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4032 ev->format = 32;
4033
4034 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4035 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4036 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4037 into that array in the event. */
4038 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4039 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4040 break;
4041
4042 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4043 {
4044 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4045 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4046 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4047
4048 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4049 nbytes);
4050 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4051 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4052 }
4053
4054 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4055 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4056 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4057 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4058 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4059 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4060
4061 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4062 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4063
4064 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4065 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4066 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4067 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4068 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4069 }
4070
4071
4072 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4073 in *IEVENT. */
4074
4075 static void
4076 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4077 XEvent *event;
4078 struct input_event *ievent;
4079 {
4080 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4081 Lisp_Object window;
4082 struct frame *f;
4083 struct window *w;
4084
4085 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4086 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4087
4088 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4089 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4090
4091 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4092 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4093 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4094 #ifdef USE_GTK
4095 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4096 #else
4097 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4098 #endif
4099 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4100 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4101 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4102 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4103 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4104 }
4105
4106
4107 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4108
4109 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4110
4111 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4112
4113
4114 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4115 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4116 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4117
4118 static void
4119 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4120 Widget widget;
4121 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4122 {
4123 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4124 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4125 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4126
4127 switch (cs->reason)
4128 {
4129 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4130 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4131 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4132 break;
4133
4134 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4135 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4136 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4137 break;
4138
4139 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4140 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4141 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4142 break;
4143
4144 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4145 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4146 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4147 break;
4148
4149 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4150 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4151 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4152 break;
4153
4154 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4155 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4156 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4157 break;
4158
4159 case XmCR_DRAG:
4160 {
4161 int slider_size;
4162
4163 /* Get the slider size. */
4164 BLOCK_INPUT;
4165 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4166 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4167
4168 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4169 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4170 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4171 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4172 }
4173 break;
4174
4175 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4176 break;
4177 };
4178
4179 if (part >= 0)
4180 {
4181 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4182 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4183 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4184 }
4185 }
4186
4187
4188 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4189 #ifdef USE_GTK
4190 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4191 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4192
4193 static void
4194 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4195 GtkRange *widget;
4196 gpointer data;
4197 {
4198 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4199 gdouble previous;
4200 gdouble position;
4201 gdouble *p;
4202 int diff;
4203
4204 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4205 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4206
4207 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4208
4209 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4210
4211 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4212 if (! p)
4213 {
4214 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4215 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4216 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4217 }
4218
4219 previous = *p;
4220 *p = position;
4221
4222 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4223
4224 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4225 {
4226 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4227 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4228 }
4229 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4230 {
4231 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4232 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4233 }
4234 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4235 {
4236 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4237 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4238 }
4239 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4240 {
4241 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4242 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4243 }
4244 else
4245 {
4246 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4247 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4248 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4249 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4250 }
4251
4252 if (part >= 0)
4253 {
4254 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4255 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4256 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4257 }
4258 }
4259
4260 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4261
4262 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4263 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4264 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4265 the thumb is. */
4266
4267 static void
4268 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4269 Widget widget;
4270 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4271 {
4272 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4273 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4274 float shown;
4275 int whole, portion, height;
4276 int part;
4277
4278 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4279 BLOCK_INPUT;
4280 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4281 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4282
4283 whole = 10000000;
4284 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4285
4286 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4287 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4288 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4289 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4290 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4291 bottom). */
4292 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4293 else
4294 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4295
4296 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4297 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4298 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4299 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4300 }
4301
4302
4303 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4304 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4305 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4306 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4307 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4308 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4309 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4310
4311 static void
4312 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4313 Widget widget;
4314 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4315 {
4316 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4317 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4318 int position = (long) call_data;
4319 Dimension height;
4320 int part;
4321
4322 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4323 BLOCK_INPUT;
4324 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4325 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4326
4327 if (abs (position) >= height)
4328 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4329
4330 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4331 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4332 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4333 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4334 else
4335 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4336
4337 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4338 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4339 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4340 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4341 }
4342
4343 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4344 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4345
4346 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4347
4348 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4349 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4350
4351 #ifdef USE_GTK
4352 static void
4353 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4354 struct frame *f;
4355 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4356 {
4357 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4358
4359 BLOCK_INPUT;
4360 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4361 scroll_bar_name);
4362 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4363 }
4364
4365 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4366
4367 static void
4368 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4369 struct frame *f;
4370 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4371 {
4372 Window xwindow;
4373 Widget widget;
4374 Arg av[20];
4375 int ac = 0;
4376 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4377 unsigned long pixel;
4378
4379 BLOCK_INPUT;
4380
4381 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4382 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4383 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4384 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4385 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4386 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4387 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4388 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4389 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4390
4391 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4392 if (pixel != -1)
4393 {
4394 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4395 ++ac;
4396 }
4397
4398 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4399 if (pixel != -1)
4400 {
4401 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4402 ++ac;
4403 }
4404
4405 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4406 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4407
4408 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4409 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4410 (XtPointer) bar);
4411 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4412 (XtPointer) bar);
4413 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4414 (XtPointer) bar);
4415 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4416 (XtPointer) bar);
4417 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4418 (XtPointer) bar);
4419 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4420 (XtPointer) bar);
4421 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4422 (XtPointer) bar);
4423
4424 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4425 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4426
4427 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4428 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4429 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4430 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4431
4432 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4433
4434 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4435 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4436 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4437 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4438 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4439 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4440 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4441 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4442
4443 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4444 if (pixel != -1)
4445 {
4446 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4447 ++ac;
4448 }
4449
4450 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4451 if (pixel != -1)
4452 {
4453 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4454 ++ac;
4455 }
4456
4457 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4458
4459 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4460 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4461 {
4462 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4463 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4464 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4465 pixel = -1;
4466 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4467 }
4468 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4469 {
4470 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4471 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4472 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4473 pixel = -1;
4474 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4475 }
4476
4477 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4478 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4479 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4480 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4481 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4482 {
4483 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4484 ++ac;
4485 }
4486 else
4487 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4488 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4489 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4490 {
4491 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4492 the shadows. */
4493 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4494 ++ac;
4495
4496 /* Specify the colors. */
4497 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4498 if (pixel != -1)
4499 {
4500 XtSetArg (av[ac], "topShadowPixel", pixel);
4501 ++ac;
4502 }
4503 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4504 if (pixel != -1)
4505 {
4506 XtSetArg (av[ac], "bottomShadowPixel", pixel);
4507 ++ac;
4508 }
4509 }
4510
4511 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4512 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4513
4514 {
4515 char *initial = "";
4516 char *val = initial;
4517 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4518 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4519 if (val == initial)
4520 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4521 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4522 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? -sm */
4523 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4524 }
4525 }
4526
4527 /* Define callbacks. */
4528 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4529 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4530 (XtPointer) bar);
4531
4532 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4533 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4534
4535 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4536
4537 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4538 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4539 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4540 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4541
4542 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4543 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4544 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4545 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4546
4547 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4548 }
4549 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4550
4551
4552 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4553 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4554
4555 #ifdef USE_GTK
4556 static void
4557 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4558 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4559 int portion, position, whole;
4560 {
4561 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4562 }
4563
4564 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4565 static void
4566 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4567 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4568 int portion, position, whole;
4569 {
4570 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4571 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4572 float top, shown;
4573
4574 BLOCK_INPUT;
4575
4576 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4577
4578 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4579 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4580 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4581 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4582 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4583 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4584 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4585 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4586 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4587 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4588 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4589 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4590 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4591 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4592 whole += portion;
4593
4594 if (whole <= 0)
4595 top = 0, shown = 1;
4596 else
4597 {
4598 top = (float) position / whole;
4599 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4600 }
4601
4602 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4603 {
4604 int size, value;
4605
4606 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4607 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4608 value. */
4609 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4610 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4611 size = max (size, 1);
4612
4613 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4614 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4615 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4616
4617 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4618 }
4619 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4620
4621 if (whole == 0)
4622 top = 0, shown = 1;
4623 else
4624 {
4625 top = (float) position / whole;
4626 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4627 }
4628
4629 {
4630 float old_top, old_shown;
4631 Dimension height;
4632 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4633 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4634 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4635 XtNheight, &height,
4636 NULL);
4637
4638 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4639 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4640 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4641 else
4642 top = old_top;
4643 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4644 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4645
4646 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4647 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4648 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4649 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4650 {
4651 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4652 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4653 else
4654 {
4655 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4656 ScrollbarWidget sb = (ScrollbarWidget) widget;
4657 int scroll_mode = 0;
4658
4659 /* `scroll_mode' only exists with Xaw3d + ARROW_SCROLLBAR. */
4660 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll)
4661 {
4662 /* Xaw3d stupidly ignores resize requests while dragging
4663 so we have to make it believe it's not in dragging mode. */
4664 scroll_mode = sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode;
4665 if (scroll_mode == 2)
4666 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = 0;
4667 }
4668 #endif
4669 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4670 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4671 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4672
4673 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4674
4675 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4676 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && scroll_mode == 2)
4677 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = scroll_mode;
4678 #endif
4679 }
4680 }
4681 }
4682 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4683
4684 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4685 }
4686 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4687
4688 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4689
4690
4691 \f
4692 /************************************************************************
4693 Scroll bars, general
4694 ************************************************************************/
4695
4696 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4697 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4698 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4699 scroll bar. */
4700
4701 static struct scroll_bar *
4702 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4703 struct window *w;
4704 int top, left, width, height;
4705 {
4706 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4707 struct scroll_bar *bar
4708 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4709
4710 BLOCK_INPUT;
4711
4712 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4713 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4714 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4715 {
4716 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4717 unsigned long mask;
4718 Window window;
4719
4720 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4721 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4722 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4723
4724 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4725 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4726 | ExposureMask);
4727 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4728
4729 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4730
4731 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4732 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4733 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4734 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4735 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4736 left, top, width,
4737 window_box_height (w), False);
4738
4739 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4740 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4741 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4742 top,
4743 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4744 height,
4745 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4746 0,
4747 CopyFromParent,
4748 CopyFromParent,
4749 CopyFromParent,
4750 /* Attributes. */
4751 mask, &a);
4752 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4753 }
4754 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4755
4756 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4757 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4758 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4759 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4760 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4761 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4762 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4763 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4764
4765 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4766 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4767 bar->prev = Qnil;
4768 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4769 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4770 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4771
4772 /* Map the window/widget. */
4773 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4774 {
4775 #ifdef USE_GTK
4776 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4777 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4778 top,
4779 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4780 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4781 max (height, 1),
4782 left,
4783 width);
4784 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4785 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4786 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4787 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4788 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4789 top,
4790 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4791 max (height, 1), 0);
4792 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4793 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4794 }
4795 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4796 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4797 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4798
4799 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4800 return bar;
4801 }
4802
4803
4804 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4805
4806 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4807 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4808 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4809 events.)
4810
4811 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4812 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4813 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4814 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4815 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4816
4817 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4818
4819 static void
4820 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4821 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4822 int start, end;
4823 int rebuild;
4824 {
4825 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4826 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4827 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4828 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4829
4830 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4831 if (! rebuild
4832 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4833 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4834 return;
4835
4836 BLOCK_INPUT;
4837
4838 {
4839 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4840 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4841 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4842
4843 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4844 the distance between start and end. */
4845 {
4846 int length = end - start;
4847
4848 if (start < 0)
4849 start = 0;
4850 else if (start > top_range)
4851 start = top_range;
4852 end = start + length;
4853
4854 if (end < start)
4855 end = start;
4856 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4857 end = top_range;
4858 }
4859
4860 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4861 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4862 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4863
4864 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4865 if (end > top_range)
4866 end = top_range;
4867
4868 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4869 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4870 that many pixels tall. */
4871 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4872
4873 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4874 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4875 if (0 < start)
4876 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4877 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4878 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4879 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4880 inside_width, start,
4881 False);
4882
4883 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4884 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4885 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4886 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4887
4888 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4889 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4890 /* x, y, width, height */
4891 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4892 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4893 inside_width, end - start);
4894
4895 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4896 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4897 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4898 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4899
4900 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4901 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4902 if (end < inside_height)
4903 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4904 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4905 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4906 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4907 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4908 False);
4909
4910 }
4911
4912 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4913 }
4914
4915 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4916
4917 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4918 nil. */
4919
4920 static void
4921 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4922 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4923 {
4924 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4925 BLOCK_INPUT;
4926
4927 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4928 #ifdef USE_GTK
4929 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4930 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4931 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4932 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4933 #else
4934 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4935 #endif
4936
4937 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
4938 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4939
4940 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4941 }
4942
4943
4944 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
4945 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
4946 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
4947 create one. */
4948
4949 static void
4950 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
4951 struct window *w;
4952 int portion, whole, position;
4953 {
4954 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4955 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4956 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
4957 int window_y, window_height;
4958
4959 /* Get window dimensions. */
4960 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
4961 top = window_y;
4962 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
4963 height = window_height;
4964
4965 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
4966 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
4967
4968 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
4969 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
4970 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
4971 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
4972 else
4973 sb_width = width;
4974
4975 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
4976 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4977 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4978 sb_left = left + width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2;
4979 else
4980 sb_left = left + (width - sb_width) / 2;
4981 #else
4982 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4983 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
4984 else
4985 sb_left = left;
4986 #endif
4987
4988 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
4989 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
4990 {
4991 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4992 {
4993 BLOCK_INPUT;
4994 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4995 left, top, width, height, False);
4996 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4997 }
4998
4999 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5000 }
5001 else
5002 {
5003 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5004 unsigned int mask = 0;
5005
5006 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5007
5008 BLOCK_INPUT;
5009
5010 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5011 mask |= CWX;
5012 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5013 mask |= CWY;
5014 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5015 mask |= CWWidth;
5016 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5017 mask |= CWHeight;
5018
5019 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5020
5021 #ifdef USE_GTK
5022 if (mask)
5023 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5024 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5025 top,
5026 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5027 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5028 max (height, 1),
5029 left,
5030 width);
5031 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5032
5033 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5034 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5035 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5036 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5037 left, top, width, height, False);
5038 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5039 if (mask)
5040 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5041 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5042 top,
5043 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5044 max (height, 1), 0);
5045
5046 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5047 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5048
5049 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5050 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5051 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5052 {
5053 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5054 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5055 height, False);
5056 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5057 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5058 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5059 height, False);
5060 }
5061
5062 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5063 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5064 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5065 example. */
5066 {
5067 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5068 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5069 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5070 {
5071 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5072 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5073 left + area_width - rest, top,
5074 rest, height, False);
5075 else
5076 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5077 left, top, rest, height, False);
5078 }
5079 }
5080
5081 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5082 if (mask)
5083 {
5084 XWindowChanges wc;
5085
5086 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5087 wc.y = top;
5088 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5089 wc.height = height;
5090 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5091 mask, &wc);
5092 }
5093
5094 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5095
5096 /* Remember new settings. */
5097 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5098 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5099 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5100 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5101
5102 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5103 }
5104
5105 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5106 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5107 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5108 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5109 dragged. */
5110 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5111 {
5112 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5113
5114 if (whole == 0)
5115 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5116 else
5117 {
5118 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5119 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5120 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5121 }
5122 }
5123 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5124
5125 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5126 }
5127
5128
5129 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5130 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5131 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5132 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5133 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5134 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5135 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5136
5137 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5138 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5139 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5140
5141 static void
5142 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5143 FRAME_PTR frame;
5144 {
5145 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5146 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5147 {
5148 Lisp_Object bar;
5149 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5150 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5151 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5152 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5153 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5154 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5155 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5156 }
5157 }
5158
5159
5160 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5161 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5162
5163 static void
5164 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5165 struct window *window;
5166 {
5167 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5168 struct frame *f;
5169
5170 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5171 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5172 abort ();
5173
5174 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5175
5176 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5177 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5178 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5179 {
5180 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5181 the lists. */
5182 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5183 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5184 return;
5185 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5186 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5187 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5188 else
5189 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5190 one or the other! */
5191 abort ();
5192 }
5193 else
5194 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5195
5196 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5197 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5198
5199 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5200 bar->prev = Qnil;
5201 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5202 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5203 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5204 }
5205
5206 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5207 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5208
5209 static void
5210 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5211 FRAME_PTR f;
5212 {
5213 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5214
5215 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5216
5217 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5218 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5219 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5220
5221 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5222 {
5223 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5224
5225 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5226
5227 next = b->next;
5228 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5229 }
5230
5231 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5232 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5233 }
5234
5235
5236 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5237 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5238 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5239
5240 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5241 mark bits. */
5242
5243 static void
5244 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5245 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5246 XEvent *event;
5247 {
5248 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5249 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5250 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5251 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5252
5253 BLOCK_INPUT;
5254
5255 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5256
5257 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5258 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5259
5260 /* x, y, width, height */
5261 0, 0,
5262 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5263 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5264
5265 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5266
5267 }
5268 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5269
5270 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5271 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5272
5273 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5274 mark bits. */
5275
5276
5277 static void
5278 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5279 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5280 XEvent *event;
5281 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5282 {
5283 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5284 abort ();
5285
5286 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5287 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5288 emacs_event->modifiers
5289 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5290 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5291 event->xbutton.state)
5292 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5293 ? up_modifier
5294 : down_modifier));
5295 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5296 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5297 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5298 {
5299 #if 0
5300 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5301 int internal_height
5302 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5303 #endif
5304 int top_range
5305 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5306 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5307
5308 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5309 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5310
5311 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5312 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5313 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5314 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5315 else
5316 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5317
5318 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5319 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5320 whether or not we're dragging. */
5321 #if 0
5322 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5323 holding it. */
5324 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5325 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5326 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5327 #endif
5328
5329 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5330 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5331 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5332 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5333 {
5334 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5335 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5336
5337 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5338 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5339 }
5340 #endif
5341
5342 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5343 #if 0
5344 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5345 the handle. */
5346 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5347 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5348 else
5349 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5350 #else
5351 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5352 #endif
5353
5354 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5355 }
5356 }
5357
5358 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5359
5360 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5361
5362 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5363 mark bits. */
5364
5365 static void
5366 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5367 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5368 XEvent *event;
5369 {
5370 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5371
5372 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5373
5374 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5375 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5376
5377 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5378 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5379 {
5380 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5381 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5382
5383 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5384 {
5385 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5386
5387 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5388 }
5389 }
5390 }
5391
5392 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5393
5394 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5395 on the scroll bar. */
5396
5397 static void
5398 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5399 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5400 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5401 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5402 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5403 unsigned long *time;
5404 {
5405 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5406 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5407 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5408 int win_x, win_y;
5409 Window dummy_window;
5410 int dummy_coord;
5411 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5412
5413 BLOCK_INPUT;
5414
5415 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5416 report that. */
5417 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5418
5419 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5420 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5421 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5422
5423 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5424 &win_x, &win_y,
5425
5426 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5427 &dummy_mask))
5428 ;
5429 else
5430 {
5431 #if 0
5432 int inside_height
5433 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5434 #endif
5435 int top_range
5436 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5437
5438 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5439
5440 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5441 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5442
5443 if (win_y < 0)
5444 win_y = 0;
5445 if (win_y > top_range)
5446 win_y = top_range;
5447
5448 *fp = f;
5449 *bar_window = bar->window;
5450
5451 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5452 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5453 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5454 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5455 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5456 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5457 else
5458 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5459
5460 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5461 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5462
5463 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5464 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5465 }
5466
5467 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5468
5469 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5470 }
5471
5472
5473 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5474 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5475 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5476 redraw them. */
5477
5478 void
5479 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5480 FRAME_PTR f;
5481 {
5482 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5483 Lisp_Object bar;
5484
5485 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5486 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5487 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5488 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5489 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5490 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5491 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5492 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5493 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5494 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5495 }
5496
5497 \f
5498 /* Define a queue to save up SelectionRequest events for later handling. */
5499
5500 struct selection_event_queue
5501 {
5502 XEvent event;
5503 struct selection_event_queue *next;
5504 };
5505
5506 static struct selection_event_queue *queue;
5507
5508 /* Nonzero means queue up certain events--don't process them yet. */
5509
5510 static int x_queue_selection_requests;
5511
5512 /* Queue up an X event *EVENT, to be processed later. */
5513
5514 static void
5515 x_queue_event (f, event)
5516 FRAME_PTR f;
5517 XEvent *event;
5518 {
5519 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp
5520 = (struct selection_event_queue *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct selection_event_queue));
5521
5522 if (queue_tmp != NULL)
5523 {
5524 queue_tmp->event = *event;
5525 queue_tmp->next = queue;
5526 queue = queue_tmp;
5527 }
5528 }
5529
5530 /* Take all the queued events and put them back
5531 so that they get processed afresh. */
5532
5533 static void
5534 x_unqueue_events (display)
5535 Display *display;
5536 {
5537 while (queue != NULL)
5538 {
5539 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp = queue;
5540 XPutBackEvent (display, &queue_tmp->event);
5541 queue = queue_tmp->next;
5542 xfree ((char *)queue_tmp);
5543 }
5544 }
5545
5546 /* Start queuing SelectionRequest events. */
5547
5548 void
5549 x_start_queuing_selection_requests (display)
5550 Display *display;
5551 {
5552 x_queue_selection_requests++;
5553 }
5554
5555 /* Stop queuing SelectionRequest events. */
5556
5557 void
5558 x_stop_queuing_selection_requests (display)
5559 Display *display;
5560 {
5561 x_queue_selection_requests--;
5562 x_unqueue_events (display);
5563 }
5564 \f
5565 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5566
5567 #if 0
5568 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5569 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5570 sometimes don't work. */
5571
5572 static Time enter_timestamp;
5573 #endif
5574
5575 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5576 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5577 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5578 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5579
5580 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5581 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5582
5583 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5584
5585 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5586 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5587
5588 static int temp_index;
5589 static short temp_buffer[100];
5590
5591 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5592 on a particular display. */
5593
5594 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5595
5596 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5597 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5598 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5599 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5600
5601 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5602
5603 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5604 do \
5605 { \
5606 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5607 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5608 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5609 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5610 if (numchars >= 1) \
5611 { \
5612 bufp->kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5613 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f); \
5614 bufp->arg = Qnil; \
5615 bufp++; \
5616 count++; \
5617 numchars--; \
5618 } \
5619 } \
5620 while (0)
5621
5622 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5623 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5624
5625
5626 enum
5627 {
5628 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5629 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5630 X_EVENT_DROP
5631 };
5632
5633 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5634 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5635 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5636
5637 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5638 this event further.
5639 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5640
5641 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5642 static int
5643 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5644 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5645 XEvent *event;
5646 {
5647 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5648 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5649 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5650 was created. */
5651
5652 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5653 event->xclient.window);
5654
5655 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5656 }
5657 #endif
5658
5659 #ifdef USE_GTK
5660 static struct x_display_info *current_dpyinfo;
5661 static struct input_event **current_bufp;
5662 static int *current_numcharsp;
5663 static int current_count;
5664 static int current_finish;
5665
5666 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5667 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5668 so we have a chanse to act on the event before GTK. */
5669 static GdkFilterReturn
5670 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5671 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5672 GdkEvent *ev;
5673 gpointer data;
5674 {
5675 XEvent *xev = (XEvent*)gxev;
5676
5677 if (current_numcharsp)
5678 {
5679 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5680 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5681 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5682 so we do it here. */
5683 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5684 if (x_filter_event (current_dpyinfo, xev))
5685 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5686 #endif
5687 current_count += handle_one_xevent (current_dpyinfo,
5688 xev,
5689 current_bufp,
5690 current_numcharsp,
5691 &current_finish);
5692 }
5693 else
5694 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, GDK_DISPLAY ());
5695
5696 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5697 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5698
5699 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5700 }
5701 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5702
5703
5704 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5705
5706 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5707 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5708 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5709
5710 Events representing keys are stored in buffer *BUFP_R,
5711 which can hold up to *NUMCHARSP characters.
5712 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5713
5714 static int
5715 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, bufp_r, numcharsp, finish)
5716 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5717 XEvent *eventp;
5718 /* register */ struct input_event **bufp_r;
5719 /* register */ int *numcharsp;
5720 int *finish;
5721 {
5722 int count = 0;
5723 int nbytes = 0;
5724 struct frame *f;
5725 struct coding_system coding;
5726 struct input_event *bufp = *bufp_r;
5727 int numchars = *numcharsp;
5728 XEvent event = *eventp;
5729
5730 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5731
5732 switch (event.type)
5733 {
5734 case ClientMessage:
5735 {
5736 if (event.xclient.message_type
5737 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5738 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5739 {
5740 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5741 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5742 {
5743 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5744 could be the shell widget window
5745 if the frame has no title bar. */
5746 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5747 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5748 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5749 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5750 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5751 #endif
5752 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5753 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5754 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5755 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5756 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5757 needed.
5758
5759 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5760 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5761 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5762 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5763 Emacs. */
5764
5765 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5766 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5767 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5768 if (f)
5769 {
5770 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5771 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5772 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5773 int count = x_catch_errors (d);
5774 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5775 /* The ICCCM says this is
5776 the only valid choice. */
5777 RevertToParent,
5778 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5779 /* This is needed to detect the error
5780 if there is an error. */
5781 XSync (d, False);
5782 x_uncatch_errors (d, count);
5783 }
5784 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5785 #endif /* 0 */
5786 }
5787 else if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5788 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5789 {
5790 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5791 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5792 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5793 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5794 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5795 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5796 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5797 session manager and one for this. */
5798 if (numchars > 0
5799 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5800 && ! x_session_have_connection ()
5801 #endif
5802 )
5803 {
5804 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5805 event.xclient.window);
5806 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5807 for a single Emacs process. */
5808 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5809 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5810 event.xclient.window,
5811 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5812 else if (f)
5813 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5814 event.xclient.window,
5815 0, 0);
5816 }
5817 }
5818 else if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5819 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5820 {
5821 struct frame *f
5822 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5823 event.xclient.window);
5824
5825 if (f)
5826 {
5827 if (numchars == 0)
5828 abort ();
5829
5830 bufp->kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5831 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
5832 bufp->arg = Qnil;
5833 bufp++;
5834
5835 count += 1;
5836 numchars -= 1;
5837 }
5838 else
5839 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5840 }
5841 }
5842 else if (event.xclient.message_type
5843 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5844 {
5845 }
5846 else if (event.xclient.message_type
5847 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5848 {
5849 int new_x, new_y;
5850 struct frame *f
5851 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5852
5853 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5854 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5855
5856 if (f)
5857 {
5858 f->left_pos = new_x;
5859 f->top_pos = new_y;
5860 }
5861 }
5862 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5863 else if (event.xclient.message_type
5864 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5865 {
5866 struct frame *f
5867 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5868 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5869 &event, NULL);
5870 }
5871 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5872 else if ((event.xclient.message_type
5873 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5874 || (event.xclient.message_type
5875 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5876 {
5877 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5878 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5879 currently never do because we are interested in
5880 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5881 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5882 struct frame *f
5883 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5884 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5885 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5886 }
5887 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5888 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5889 we construct an input_event. */
5890 else if (event.xclient.message_type
5891 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5892 {
5893 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, bufp);
5894 ++bufp, ++count, --numchars;
5895 goto out;
5896 }
5897 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5898 else
5899 goto OTHER;
5900 }
5901 break;
5902
5903 case SelectionNotify:
5904 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5905 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5906 goto OTHER;
5907 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5908 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5909 break;
5910
5911 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5912 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5913 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5914 goto OTHER;
5915 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5916 {
5917 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5918
5919 if (numchars == 0)
5920 abort ();
5921
5922 bufp->kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5923 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (bufp) = eventp->display;
5924 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (bufp) = eventp->selection;
5925 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (bufp) = eventp->time;
5926 bufp->frame_or_window = Qnil;
5927 bufp->arg = Qnil;
5928 bufp++;
5929
5930 count += 1;
5931 numchars -= 1;
5932 }
5933 break;
5934
5935 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5936 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5937 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5938 goto OTHER;
5939 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5940 if (x_queue_selection_requests)
5941 x_queue_event (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner),
5942 &event);
5943 else
5944 {
5945 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5946 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5947
5948 if (numchars == 0)
5949 abort ();
5950
5951 bufp->kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5952 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (bufp) = eventp->display;
5953 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (bufp) = eventp->requestor;
5954 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (bufp) = eventp->selection;
5955 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (bufp) = eventp->target;
5956 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (bufp) = eventp->property;
5957 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (bufp) = eventp->time;
5958 bufp->frame_or_window = Qnil;
5959 bufp->arg = Qnil;
5960 bufp++;
5961
5962 count += 1;
5963 numchars -= 1;
5964 }
5965 break;
5966
5967 case PropertyNotify:
5968 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5969 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5970 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
5971 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
5972 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
5973 goto OTHER;
5974 #endif
5975 #endif
5976 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5977 goto OTHER;
5978
5979 case ReparentNotify:
5980 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5981 if (f)
5982 {
5983 int x, y;
5984 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5985 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5986 f->left_pos = x;
5987 f->top_pos = y;
5988 }
5989 goto OTHER;
5990 break;
5991
5992 case Expose:
5993 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5994 if (f)
5995 {
5996 x_check_fullscreen (f);
5997
5998 if (f->async_visible == 0)
5999 {
6000 f->async_visible = 1;
6001 f->async_iconified = 0;
6002 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6003 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6004 }
6005 else
6006 expose_frame (f,
6007 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6008 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6009 }
6010 else
6011 {
6012 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6013 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6014 #endif
6015 #if defined USE_LUCID
6016 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6017 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6018 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6019 {
6020 Widget widget
6021 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6022 if (widget)
6023 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6024 }
6025 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6026
6027 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6028 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6029 goto OTHER;
6030 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6031 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6032
6033 if (bar)
6034 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6035 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6036 else
6037 goto OTHER;
6038 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6039 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6040 }
6041 break;
6042
6043 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6044 source area was obscured or not
6045 available. */
6046 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6047 if (f)
6048 {
6049 expose_frame (f,
6050 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6051 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6052 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6053 }
6054 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6055 else
6056 goto OTHER;
6057 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6058 break;
6059
6060 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6061 source area was completely
6062 available. */
6063 break;
6064
6065 case UnmapNotify:
6066 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6067 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6068 {
6069 tip_window = 0;
6070 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6071 }
6072
6073 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6074 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6075 the frame was deleted. */
6076 {
6077 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6078 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6079 display that won't ever be seen. */
6080 f->async_visible = 0;
6081 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6082 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6083 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6084 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6085 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6086 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6087 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6088 {
6089 f->async_iconified = 1;
6090
6091 bufp->kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6092 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6093 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6094 bufp++;
6095 count++;
6096 numchars--;
6097 }
6098 }
6099 goto OTHER;
6100
6101 case MapNotify:
6102 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6103 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6104 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6105 goto OTHER;
6106
6107 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6108 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6109 frame is visible. */
6110 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6111 if (f)
6112 {
6113 /* wait_reading_process_input will notice this and update
6114 the frame's display structures.
6115 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6116 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6117 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6118 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6119 if (! f->async_iconified)
6120 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6121
6122 f->async_visible = 1;
6123 f->async_iconified = 0;
6124 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6125
6126 if (f->iconified)
6127 {
6128 bufp->kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6129 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6130 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6131 bufp++;
6132 count++;
6133 numchars--;
6134 }
6135 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6136 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6137 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6138 to update the frame titles
6139 in case this is the second frame. */
6140 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6141 }
6142 goto OTHER;
6143
6144 case KeyPress:
6145
6146 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6147 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6148 if (popup_activated ())
6149 goto OTHER;
6150 #endif
6151
6152 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6153
6154 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight))
6155 {
6156 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6157 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6158 }
6159
6160 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6161 if (f == 0)
6162 {
6163 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6164 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6165 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6166 event.xkey.window);
6167 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6168 {
6169 widget = XtParent (widget);
6170 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6171 }
6172 }
6173 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6174
6175 if (f != 0)
6176 {
6177 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6178 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6179 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6180 his Emacs hang.
6181
6182 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6183 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6184 status_return even if the input is too long to
6185 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6186 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6187 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6188 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6189 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6190 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6191 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6192 int modifiers;
6193 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6194
6195 event.xkey.state
6196 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6197 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6198 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6199
6200 /* This will have to go some day... */
6201
6202 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6203 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6204 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6205 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6206 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6207 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6208 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6209
6210 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6211 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6212 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6213 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6214 not it is combined with Meta. */
6215 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6216 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6217
6218 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6219 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6220 {
6221 Status status_return;
6222
6223 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6224 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6225 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6226 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6227 &status_return);
6228 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6229 {
6230 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6231 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6232 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6233 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6234 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6235 &status_return);
6236 }
6237 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6238 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6239 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6240 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6241 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6242 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6243 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6244 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6245 &status_return);
6246 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6247 {
6248 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6249 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6250 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6251 &event.xkey,
6252 copy_bufptr,
6253 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6254 &status_return);
6255 }
6256 }
6257 #endif
6258
6259 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6260 break;
6261 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6262 {
6263 keysym = NoSymbol;
6264 modifiers = 0;
6265 }
6266 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6267 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6268 abort ();
6269 }
6270 else
6271 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6272 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6273 &compose_status);
6274 #else
6275 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6276 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6277 &compose_status);
6278 #endif
6279
6280 orig_keysym = keysym;
6281
6282 if (numchars > 1)
6283 {
6284 Lisp_Object c;
6285
6286 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6287 translations to characters. */
6288 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6289 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6290 {
6291 bufp->kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6292 bufp->code = keysym;
6293 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6294 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6295 bufp->modifiers
6296 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6297 modifiers);
6298 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6299 bufp++;
6300 count++;
6301 numchars--;
6302 }
6303 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6304 else if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6305 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6306 Vx_keysym_table,
6307 Qnil))))
6308 {
6309 bufp->kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6310 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6311 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6312 bufp->code = XFASTINT (c);
6313 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6314 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6315 bufp->modifiers
6316 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6317 modifiers);
6318 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6319 bufp++;
6320 count++;
6321 numchars--;
6322 }
6323 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6324 else if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6325 || keysym == XK_Delete
6326 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6327 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6328 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6329 #endif
6330 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6331 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6332 #ifdef HPUX
6333 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6334 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6335 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6336 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6337 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6338 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6339 #endif
6340 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6341 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6342 #endif
6343 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6344 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6345 #endif
6346 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6347 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6348 #endif
6349 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6350 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6351 #endif
6352 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6353 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6354 #endif
6355 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6356 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6357 #endif
6358 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6359 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6360 #endif
6361 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6362 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6363 #endif
6364 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6365 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6366 #endif
6367 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6368 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6369 #endif
6370 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6371 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6372 #endif
6373 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6374 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6375 #endif
6376 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6377 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6378 #endif
6379 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6380 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6381 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6382 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6383 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6384 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6385 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6386 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6387 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6388 #endif
6389 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6390 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6391 #endif
6392 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6393 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6394 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6395 don't have real modifiers but
6396 should be treated similarly to
6397 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6398 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6399 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6400 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6401 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6402 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6403 #endif
6404 ))
6405 {
6406 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short))
6407 temp_index = 0;
6408 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = keysym;
6409 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6410 key. */
6411 bufp->kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6412 bufp->code = keysym;
6413 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6414 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6415 bufp->modifiers
6416 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6417 modifiers);
6418 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6419 bufp++;
6420 count++;
6421 numchars--;
6422 }
6423 else if (numchars > nbytes)
6424 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6425 register int i;
6426 register int c;
6427 int nchars, len;
6428
6429 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6430 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6431 we used just above and the locale. */
6432 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6433 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6434 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6435 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6436 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6437 gives us composition information. */
6438 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6439
6440 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6441 {
6442 if (temp_index == (sizeof temp_buffer
6443 / sizeof (short)))
6444 temp_index = 0;
6445 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = copy_bufptr[i];
6446 }
6447
6448 {
6449 /* Decode the input data. */
6450 int require;
6451 unsigned char *p;
6452
6453 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6454 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6455 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6456 /* We explicitly disable composition
6457 handling because key data should
6458 not contain any composition
6459 sequence. */
6460 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6461 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p,
6462 nbytes, require);
6463 nbytes = coding.produced;
6464 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6465 copy_bufptr = p;
6466 }
6467
6468 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6469 character events. */
6470 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6471 {
6472 if (nchars == nbytes)
6473 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6474 else
6475 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6476 nbytes - i, len);
6477
6478 bufp->kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6479 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6480 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6481 bufp->code = c;
6482 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6483 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6484 bufp->modifiers
6485 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6486 modifiers);
6487 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6488 bufp++;
6489 }
6490
6491 count += nchars;
6492 numchars -= nchars;
6493
6494 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6495 break;
6496 }
6497 else
6498 abort ();
6499 }
6500 else
6501 abort ();
6502 }
6503 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6504 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6505 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6506 client. */
6507 break;
6508 #else
6509 goto OTHER;
6510 #endif
6511
6512 case KeyRelease:
6513 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6514 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6515 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6516 client. */
6517 break;
6518 #else
6519 goto OTHER;
6520 #endif
6521
6522 case EnterNotify:
6523 {
6524 int n;
6525
6526 n = x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, bufp, numchars);
6527 if (n > 0)
6528 {
6529 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6530 }
6531
6532 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6533
6534 #if 0
6535 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6536 {
6537 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6538 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6539 || !(f->auto_lower)
6540 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6541 {
6542 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6543 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6544 }
6545 }
6546 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6547 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6548 #endif
6549
6550 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6551 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6552 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6553 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6554 goto OTHER;
6555 }
6556
6557 case FocusIn:
6558 {
6559 int n;
6560
6561 n = x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, bufp, numchars);
6562 if (n > 0)
6563 {
6564 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6565 }
6566 }
6567
6568 goto OTHER;
6569
6570 case LeaveNotify:
6571 {
6572 int n;
6573
6574 n = x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, bufp, numchars);
6575 if (n > 0)
6576 {
6577 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6578 }
6579 }
6580
6581 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6582 if (f)
6583 {
6584 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6585 {
6586 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6587 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6588 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6589 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6590 }
6591
6592 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6593 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6594 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6595 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6596 if (any_help_event_p)
6597 {
6598 Lisp_Object frame;
6599 int n;
6600
6601 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6602 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6603 n = gen_help_event (bufp, numchars,
6604 Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6605 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6606 }
6607
6608 }
6609 goto OTHER;
6610
6611 case FocusOut:
6612 {
6613 int n;
6614
6615 n = x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, bufp, numchars);
6616 if (n > 0)
6617 {
6618 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6619 }
6620 }
6621
6622 goto OTHER;
6623
6624 case MotionNotify:
6625 {
6626 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6627 help_echo_string = help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
6628 help_echo_pos = -1;
6629
6630 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6631 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6632 f = last_mouse_frame;
6633 else
6634 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6635
6636 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6637 {
6638 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6639 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6640 }
6641
6642 if (f)
6643 {
6644
6645 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6646 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
6647 {
6648 Lisp_Object window;
6649
6650 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6651 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6652 0, 0, 0, 0);
6653
6654 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6655 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6656 will be selected iff it is active. */
6657 if (WINDOWP(window)
6658 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6659 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6660 && numchars > 0)
6661 {
6662 bufp->kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6663 bufp->frame_or_window = window;
6664 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6665 ++bufp, ++count, --numchars;
6666 }
6667
6668 last_window=window;
6669 }
6670 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6671 }
6672 else
6673 {
6674 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6675 struct scroll_bar *bar
6676 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.window);
6677
6678 if (bar)
6679 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6680 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6681
6682 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6683 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6684 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6685 }
6686
6687 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6688 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6689 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6690 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6691 {
6692 Lisp_Object frame;
6693 int n;
6694
6695 if (f)
6696 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6697 else
6698 frame = Qnil;
6699
6700 any_help_event_p = 1;
6701 n = gen_help_event (bufp, numchars, help_echo_string, frame,
6702 help_echo_window, help_echo_object,
6703 help_echo_pos);
6704 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6705 }
6706
6707 goto OTHER;
6708 }
6709
6710 case ConfigureNotify:
6711 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6712 if (f)
6713 {
6714 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6715 #ifdef USE_GTK
6716 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6717 event.xconfigure.height);
6718 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6719 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6720 do this one, the right one will come later.
6721 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6722 need to reset it below. */
6723 int dont_resize
6724 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6725 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6726 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6727 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6728
6729 if (dont_resize)
6730 goto OTHER;
6731
6732 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6733 is called by the code that handles resizing
6734 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6735
6736 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6737 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6738 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6739 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6740 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6741 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6742 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6743 {
6744 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6745 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6746 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6747 }
6748 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6749 #endif
6750
6751 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6752 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6753
6754 #ifdef USE_GTK
6755 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6756 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6757 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6758 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6759 #endif
6760 {
6761 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
6762 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
6763 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6764
6765 x_check_fullscreen_move (f);
6766 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6767 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6768 }
6769
6770 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6771 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6772 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6773 #endif
6774
6775 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6776 {
6777 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6778 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6779 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6780 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6781 }
6782 }
6783 goto OTHER;
6784
6785 case ButtonRelease:
6786 case ButtonPress:
6787 {
6788 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6789 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6790 struct input_event emacs_event;
6791 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6792
6793 emacs_event.kind = NO_EVENT;
6794 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6795
6796 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6797 && last_mouse_frame
6798 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6799 f = last_mouse_frame;
6800 else
6801 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6802
6803 if (f)
6804 {
6805 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6806 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6807 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6808 {
6809 Lisp_Object window;
6810 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6811 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6812
6813 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6814 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6815 {
6816 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6817 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6818 else
6819 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6820 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6821 event.xbutton.state));
6822 tool_bar_p = 1;
6823 }
6824 }
6825
6826 if (!tool_bar_p)
6827 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6828 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6829 {
6830 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6831 if (! popup_activated ())
6832 #endif
6833 construct_mouse_click (&emacs_event, &event, f);
6834 }
6835 }
6836 else
6837 {
6838 struct scroll_bar *bar
6839 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.window);
6840
6841 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6842 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6843 scroll bars. */
6844 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6845 {
6846 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &emacs_event);
6847 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6848 }
6849 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6850 if (bar)
6851 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &emacs_event);
6852 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6853 }
6854
6855 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6856 {
6857 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6858 last_mouse_frame = f;
6859 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened
6860 before this event; any subsequent mouse-movement
6861 Emacs events should reflect only motion after
6862 the ButtonPress. */
6863 if (f != 0)
6864 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6865
6866 if (!tool_bar_p)
6867 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6868 }
6869 else
6870 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6871
6872 if (numchars >= 1 && emacs_event.kind != NO_EVENT)
6873 {
6874 bcopy (&emacs_event, bufp, sizeof (struct input_event));
6875 bufp++;
6876 count++;
6877 numchars--;
6878 }
6879
6880 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6881 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6882 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6883 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6884 Instead, save it away
6885 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6886 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6887 if (
6888 #ifdef USE_GTK
6889 ! popup_activated ()
6890 &&
6891 #endif
6892 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6893 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6894 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6895 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6896 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6897 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6898 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6899 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6900 {
6901 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6902 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6903 #ifdef USE_GTK
6904 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6905 #endif
6906 }
6907 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6908 {
6909 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6910 goto OTHER;
6911 }
6912
6913 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6914 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6915 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6916 {
6917 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6918 {
6919 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6920 if (f->output_data.x)
6921 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6922 }
6923 else
6924 goto OTHER;
6925 }
6926 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6927 else
6928 goto OTHER;
6929 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6930 }
6931 break;
6932
6933 case CirculateNotify:
6934 goto OTHER;
6935
6936 case CirculateRequest:
6937 goto OTHER;
6938
6939 case VisibilityNotify:
6940 goto OTHER;
6941
6942 case MappingNotify:
6943 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6944 local cache. */
6945 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6946 {
6947 case MappingModifier:
6948 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6949 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6950 case MappingKeyboard:
6951 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6952 }
6953 goto OTHER;
6954
6955 default:
6956 OTHER:
6957 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6958 BLOCK_INPUT;
6959 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6960 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6961 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6962 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6963 break;
6964 }
6965
6966 goto ret;
6967
6968 out:
6969 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6970
6971 ret:
6972 *bufp_r = bufp;
6973 *numcharsp = numchars;
6974 *eventp = event;
6975
6976 return count;
6977 }
6978
6979
6980 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6981 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6982 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6983
6984 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6985 int
6986 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6987 XEvent *event;
6988 Display *display;
6989 {
6990 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6991 struct input_event bufp[10];
6992 struct input_event *bufpp = bufp;
6993 int numchars = 10;
6994 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6995
6996 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
6997 if (dpyinfo->display == display)
6998 break;
6999
7000 if (dpyinfo)
7001 {
7002 int i, events;
7003 events = handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo,
7004 event,
7005 &bufpp,
7006 &numchars,
7007 &finish);
7008 for (i = 0; i < events; ++i)
7009 kbd_buffer_store_event (&bufp[i]);
7010 }
7011
7012 return finish;
7013 }
7014
7015
7016 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7017 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7018 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7019
7020 Events representing keys are stored in buffer BUFP,
7021 which can hold up to NUMCHARS characters.
7022 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7023 thus pretending to be `read'.
7024
7025 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7026
7027 static int
7028 XTread_socket (sd, bufp, numchars, expected)
7029 register int sd;
7030 /* register */ struct input_event *bufp;
7031 /* register */ int numchars;
7032 int expected;
7033 {
7034 int count = 0;
7035 XEvent event;
7036 int event_found = 0;
7037 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7038
7039 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7040 {
7041 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7042 return -1;
7043 }
7044
7045 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7046 BLOCK_INPUT;
7047
7048 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7049 input_signal_count++;
7050
7051 if (numchars <= 0)
7052 abort (); /* Don't think this happens. */
7053
7054 ++handling_signal;
7055
7056 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
7057 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
7058 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
7059 {
7060 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
7061 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
7062 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
7063 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
7064 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
7065 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
7066 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
7067 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
7068 #endif
7069
7070 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
7071 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
7072 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
7073 for X connections. */
7074 #ifndef SIGIO
7075 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
7076 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
7077 {
7078 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
7079 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
7080 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7081 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
7082 }
7083 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7084 #endif /* SIGIO */
7085 #endif
7086
7087 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7088 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7089 {
7090 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7091 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7092 }
7093
7094 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7095 BLOCK_INPUT;
7096 count += x_session_check_input (bufp, &numchars);
7097 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7098 #endif
7099
7100 #ifdef USE_GTK
7101 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7102 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7103 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7104 that is kind of ugly, but it works. */
7105 current_dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
7106
7107 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7108 {
7109 current_count = count;
7110 current_numcharsp = &numchars;
7111 current_bufp = &bufp;
7112
7113 gtk_main_iteration ();
7114
7115 count = current_count;
7116 current_bufp = 0;
7117 current_numcharsp = 0;
7118
7119 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7120 goto out;
7121 }
7122
7123 #else /* not USE_GTK */
7124 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7125 {
7126 int finish;
7127
7128 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7129
7130 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7131 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7132 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7133 break;
7134 #endif
7135 event_found = 1;
7136
7137 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo,
7138 &event,
7139 &bufp,
7140 &numchars,
7141 &finish);
7142
7143 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7144 goto out;
7145 }
7146 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7147 }
7148
7149 out:;
7150
7151 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7152 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7153 if (! event_found)
7154 {
7155 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7156 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7157 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7158 x_noop_count++;
7159 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7160 {
7161 x_noop_count=0;
7162
7163 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7164 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7165
7166 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7167
7168 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7169 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7170 }
7171 }
7172
7173 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7174 raise it now. */
7175 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7176 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7177 {
7178 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7179 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7180 }
7181
7182 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7183 --handling_signal;
7184 return count;
7185 }
7186
7187
7188
7189 \f
7190 /***********************************************************************
7191 Text Cursor
7192 ***********************************************************************/
7193
7194 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7195 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7196
7197 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7198 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7199 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7200
7201 static void
7202 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc)
7203 struct window *w;
7204 struct glyph_row *row;
7205 GC gc;
7206 {
7207 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7208 XRectangle clip_rect;
7209 int window_y, window_width;
7210
7211 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7212
7213 clip_rect.x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0);
7214 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
7215 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7216 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7217 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7218
7219 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7220 }
7221
7222
7223 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7224
7225 static void
7226 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7227 struct window *w;
7228 struct glyph_row *row;
7229 {
7230 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7231 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7232 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7233 int x, y, wd, h;
7234 XGCValues xgcv;
7235 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7236 GC gc;
7237
7238 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates from window-relative
7239 coordinates. */
7240 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7241 y = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y)
7242 + row->ascent - w->phys_cursor_ascent);
7243 h = row->height - 1;
7244
7245 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7246 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7247 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7248 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7249 return;
7250
7251 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
7252 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
7253 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
7254 width instead. */
7255 wd = cursor_glyph->pixel_width - 1;
7256 if (cursor_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
7257 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
7258 wd = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f), wd);
7259 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
7260
7261 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7262 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7263 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7264 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7265 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7266 else
7267 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7268 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7269 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7270
7271 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7272 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
7273 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
7274 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7275 }
7276
7277
7278 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7279
7280 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7281 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7282 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7283 --gerd. */
7284
7285 static void
7286 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7287 struct window *w;
7288 struct glyph_row *row;
7289 int width;
7290 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7291 {
7292 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7293 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7294
7295 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7296 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7297 and mini-buffer. */
7298 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7299 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7300 return;
7301
7302 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7303 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7304 the bar might not be in the window. */
7305 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7306 {
7307 struct glyph_row *row;
7308 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7309 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7310 }
7311 else
7312 {
7313 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7314 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7315 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7316 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7317 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7318 XGCValues xgcv;
7319
7320 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7321 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7322 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7323 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7324 that the glyph is legible. */
7325 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7326 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7327 else
7328 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7329 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7330
7331 if (gc)
7332 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7333 else
7334 {
7335 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7336 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7337 }
7338
7339 if (width < 0)
7340 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7341 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7342
7343 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7344 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
7345
7346 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7347 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7348 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7349 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7350 width, row->height);
7351 else
7352 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7353 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7354 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7355 row->height - width),
7356 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7357 width);
7358
7359 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7360 }
7361 }
7362
7363
7364 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7365
7366 static void
7367 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7368 struct frame *f;
7369 Cursor cursor;
7370 {
7371 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7372 }
7373
7374
7375 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7376
7377 static void
7378 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7379 struct frame *f;
7380 int x, y, width, height;
7381 {
7382 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7383 x, y, width, height, False);
7384 }
7385
7386
7387 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7388
7389 static void
7390 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7391 struct window *w;
7392 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7393 int x, y;
7394 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7395 int on_p, active_p;
7396 {
7397 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7398
7399 if (on_p)
7400 {
7401 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7402 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7403
7404 switch (cursor_type)
7405 {
7406 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7407 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7408 break;
7409
7410 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7411 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7412 break;
7413
7414 case BAR_CURSOR:
7415 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7416 break;
7417
7418 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7419 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7420 break;
7421
7422 case NO_CURSOR:
7423 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7424 break;
7425
7426 default:
7427 abort ();
7428 }
7429
7430 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7431 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7432 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7433 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7434 #endif
7435 }
7436
7437 #ifndef XFlush
7438 if (updating_frame != f)
7439 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7440 #endif
7441 }
7442
7443 \f
7444 /* Icons. */
7445
7446 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7447
7448 int
7449 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7450 struct frame *f;
7451 Lisp_Object file;
7452 {
7453 int bitmap_id;
7454
7455 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7456 return 1;
7457
7458 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap if any. */
7459 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7460 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7461 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7462
7463 if (STRINGP (file))
7464 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7465 else
7466 {
7467 /* Create the GNU bitmap if necessary. */
7468 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7469 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id
7470 = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_bits,
7471 gnu_width, gnu_height);
7472
7473 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap,
7474 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7475 As a result, the GNU bitmap is never freed.
7476 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7477 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7478
7479 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7480 }
7481
7482 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7483 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7484
7485 return 0;
7486 }
7487
7488
7489 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7490 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7491
7492 int
7493 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7494 struct frame *f;
7495 char *icon_name;
7496 {
7497 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7498 return 1;
7499
7500 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7501 {
7502 XTextProperty text;
7503 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7504 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7505 text.format = 8;
7506 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7507 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7508 }
7509 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7510 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7511 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7512
7513 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7514 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7515 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7516 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7517
7518 return 0;
7519 }
7520 \f
7521 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7522
7523 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7524 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
7525
7526 static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
7527
7528 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7529 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
7530 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7531
7532 static void
7533 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7534 Display *display;
7535 XErrorEvent *error;
7536 {
7537 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7538 SDATA (x_error_message_string),
7539 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7540 }
7541
7542 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7543 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7544 operating on.
7545
7546 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7547 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7548 stored in x_error_message_string.
7549
7550 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7551 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7552
7553 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7554
7555 void x_check_errors ();
7556 static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
7557
7558 int
7559 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7560 Display *dpy;
7561 {
7562 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7563
7564 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7565 XSync (dpy, False);
7566
7567 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind,
7568 Fcons (make_save_value (dpy, 0),
7569 x_error_message_string));
7570
7571 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7572 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7573
7574 return count;
7575 }
7576
7577 /* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
7578
7579 static Lisp_Object
7580 x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
7581 Lisp_Object old_val;
7582 {
7583 Lisp_Object first;
7584
7585 first = XCAR (old_val);
7586
7587 XSync (XSAVE_VALUE (first)->pointer, False);
7588
7589 x_error_message_string = XCDR (old_val);
7590 return Qnil;
7591 }
7592
7593 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7594 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7595 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7596
7597 void
7598 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7599 Display *dpy;
7600 char *format;
7601 {
7602 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7603 XSync (dpy, False);
7604
7605 if (SREF (x_error_message_string, 0))
7606 error (format, SDATA (x_error_message_string));
7607 }
7608
7609 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7610 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7611
7612 int
7613 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7614 Display *dpy;
7615 {
7616 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7617 XSync (dpy, False);
7618
7619 return SREF (x_error_message_string, 0) != 0;
7620 }
7621
7622 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7623
7624 void
7625 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7626 Display *dpy;
7627 {
7628 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7629 }
7630
7631 /* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
7632 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
7633 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
7634 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
7635
7636 void
7637 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
7638 Display *dpy;
7639 int count;
7640 {
7641 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
7642 }
7643
7644 #if 0
7645 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7646 x_trace_wire ()
7647 {
7648 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7649 }
7650 #endif /* ! 0 */
7651
7652 \f
7653 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7654 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7655 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7656 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7657 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7658
7659 static SIGTYPE
7660 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7661 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7662 {
7663 #ifdef USG
7664 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7665 must reestablish each time */
7666 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7667 #endif /* USG */
7668 }
7669
7670 \f
7671 /************************************************************************
7672 Handling X errors
7673 ************************************************************************/
7674
7675 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7676
7677 static char *error_msg;
7678
7679 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7680 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7681 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7682
7683 static void
7684 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7685 {
7686 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7687 exit (70);
7688 }
7689
7690 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7691 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7692
7693 static SIGTYPE
7694 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7695 Display *dpy;
7696 char *error_message;
7697 {
7698 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7699 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7700 int count;
7701
7702 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7703 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7704 handling_signal = 0;
7705
7706 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7707 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7708 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7709 the original message here. */
7710 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
7711
7712 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7713 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7714 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7715
7716 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7717 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7718 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7719
7720 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7721 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7722
7723 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7724 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7725 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7726
7727 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7728 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7729 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7730 if (dpyinfo)
7731 {
7732 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7733 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7734 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7735 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7736 }
7737 #endif
7738
7739 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7740 if (dpyinfo)
7741 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7742
7743 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7744 that are on the dead display. */
7745 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7746 {
7747 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7748 minibuf_frame
7749 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7750 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7751 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7752 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7753 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7754 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7755 }
7756
7757 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7758 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7759 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7760 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7761 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7762 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7763 {
7764 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7765 trying to find a replacement. */
7766 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7767 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7768 }
7769
7770 if (dpyinfo)
7771 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7772
7773 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
7774
7775 if (x_display_list == 0)
7776 {
7777 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7778 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7779 exit (70);
7780 }
7781
7782 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7783 #ifdef SIGIO
7784 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7785 #endif
7786 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7787 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7788
7789 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7790 error ("%s", error_msg);
7791 }
7792
7793
7794 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7795 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7796 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7797
7798 static void
7799 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7800 Display *display;
7801 XErrorEvent *error;
7802 {
7803 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7804
7805 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7806 original error handler. */
7807
7808 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7809 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7810 buf, error->request_code);
7811 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7812 }
7813
7814
7815 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7816 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7817
7818 static int
7819 x_error_handler (display, error)
7820 Display *display;
7821 XErrorEvent *error;
7822 {
7823 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
7824 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7825 else
7826 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7827 return 0;
7828 }
7829
7830 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7831 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7832 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7833
7834 static int
7835 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7836 Display *display;
7837 {
7838 char buf[256];
7839
7840 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7841 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7842 return 0;
7843 }
7844 \f
7845 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7846
7847 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7848 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7849 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7850 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7851
7852 Lisp_Object
7853 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7854 struct frame *f;
7855 register char *fontname;
7856 {
7857 struct font_info *fontp
7858 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7859
7860 if (!fontp)
7861 return Qnil;
7862
7863 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7864 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7865 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7866
7867 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = FONT_WIDTH (FRAME_FONT (f));
7868 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7869
7870 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7871
7872 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7873 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7874 {
7875 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7876 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7877 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7878 }
7879 else
7880 {
7881 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7882 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7883 }
7884
7885 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7886 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7887 {
7888 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7889 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7890 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7891 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7892 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7893 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7894
7895 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7896 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7897 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7898 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7899 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7900 }
7901
7902 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7903 }
7904
7905 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7906 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7907 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7908 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7909
7910 Lisp_Object
7911 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7912 struct frame *f;
7913 char *fontsetname;
7914 {
7915 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7916 Lisp_Object result;
7917
7918 if (fontset < 0)
7919 return Qnil;
7920
7921 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7922 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7923 to do. */
7924 return fontset_name (fontset);
7925
7926 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7927
7928 if (!STRINGP (result))
7929 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7930 return Qnil;
7931
7932 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7933 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7934
7935 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7936 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7937 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7938 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7939 #endif
7940
7941 return build_string (fontsetname);
7942 }
7943
7944 \f
7945 /***********************************************************************
7946 X Input Methods
7947 ***********************************************************************/
7948
7949 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7950
7951 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7952
7953 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7954 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7955 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7956
7957 static void
7958 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
7959 XIM xim;
7960 XPointer client_data;
7961 XPointer call_data;
7962 {
7963 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7964 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7965
7966 BLOCK_INPUT;
7967
7968 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7969 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7970 {
7971 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7972 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7973 {
7974 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7975 if (FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f))
7976 {
7977 XFreeFontSet (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f));
7978 FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f) = NULL;
7979 }
7980 }
7981 }
7982
7983 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7984 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7985 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7986 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7987 }
7988
7989 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7990
7991 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7992 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7993 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
7994 #endif
7995
7996 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7997 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7998
7999 static void
8000 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8001 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8002 char *resource_name;
8003 {
8004 XIM xim;
8005
8006 if (use_xim)
8007 {
8008 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8009 EMACS_CLASS);
8010 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8011
8012 if (xim)
8013 {
8014 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8015 XIMCallback destroy;
8016 #endif
8017
8018 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8019 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8020
8021 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8022 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8023 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8024 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8025 #endif
8026 }
8027 }
8028
8029 else
8030 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8031 }
8032
8033
8034 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8035
8036 struct xim_inst_t
8037 {
8038 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8039 char *resource_name;
8040 };
8041
8042 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8043 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8044 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8045 when the callback was registered. */
8046
8047 static void
8048 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8049 Display *display;
8050 XPointer client_data;
8051 XPointer call_data;
8052 {
8053 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8054 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8055
8056 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8057 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8058 return;
8059
8060 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8061
8062 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8063 as they have no XIC. */
8064 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8065 {
8066 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8067
8068 BLOCK_INPUT;
8069 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8070 {
8071 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8072
8073 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8074 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8075 {
8076 create_frame_xic (f);
8077 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8078 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8079 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8080 {
8081 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8082 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8083 }
8084 }
8085 }
8086
8087 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8088 }
8089 }
8090
8091 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8092
8093
8094 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8095 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8096 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8097 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8098
8099 static void
8100 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8101 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8102 char *resource_name;
8103 {
8104 if (use_xim)
8105 {
8106 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8107 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8108 int len;
8109
8110 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8111 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8112 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8113 len = strlen (resource_name);
8114 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8115 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8116 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8117 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8118 xim_instantiate_callback,
8119 /* Fixme: This is XPointer in
8120 XFree86 but (XPointer *) on
8121 Tru64, at least. */
8122 (XPointer) xim_inst);
8123 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8124 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8125 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8126 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8127
8128 }
8129 else
8130 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8131 }
8132
8133
8134 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8135
8136 static void
8137 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8138 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8139 {
8140 if (use_xim)
8141 {
8142 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8143 if (dpyinfo->display)
8144 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8145 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8146 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8147 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8148 if (dpyinfo->display)
8149 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8150 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8151 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8152 }
8153 }
8154
8155 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8156
8157
8158 \f
8159 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8160 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8161
8162 void
8163 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8164 struct frame *f;
8165 {
8166 Window child;
8167 int win_x = 0, win_y = 0;
8168 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8169 int this_window;
8170
8171 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8172 is already for the top-left corner. */
8173 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8174 return;
8175
8176 this_window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8177
8178 /* Find the position of the outside upper-left corner of
8179 the inner window, with respect to the outer window.
8180 But do this only if we will need the results. */
8181 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8182 {
8183 int count;
8184
8185 BLOCK_INPUT;
8186 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8187 while (1)
8188 {
8189 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8190 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8191
8192 /* From-window, to-window. */
8193 this_window,
8194 f->output_data.x->parent_desc,
8195
8196 /* From-position, to-position. */
8197 0, 0, &win_x, &win_y,
8198
8199 /* Child of win. */
8200 &child);
8201 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
8202 {
8203 Window newroot, newparent = 0xdeadbeef;
8204 Window *newchildren;
8205 unsigned int nchildren;
8206
8207 if (! XQueryTree (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), this_window, &newroot,
8208 &newparent, &newchildren, &nchildren))
8209 break;
8210
8211 XFree ((char *) newchildren);
8212
8213 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = newparent;
8214 }
8215 else
8216 break;
8217 }
8218
8219 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
8220 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8221 }
8222
8223 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8224 position that fits on the screen. */
8225 if (flags & XNegative)
8226 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8227 - 2 * f->border_width - win_x
8228 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
8229 + f->left_pos);
8230
8231 {
8232 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8233
8234 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8235 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8236 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8237
8238 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8239 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8240 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8241 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8242 is right, though.
8243
8244 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8245 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8246
8247 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8248 #endif
8249
8250 if (flags & YNegative)
8251 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height
8252 - 2 * f->border_width
8253 - win_y
8254 - height
8255 + f->top_pos);
8256 }
8257
8258 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8259 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8260 so the flags should correspond. */
8261 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8262 }
8263
8264 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8265 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8266 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8267 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8268 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8269
8270 void
8271 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8272 struct frame *f;
8273 register int xoff, yoff;
8274 int change_gravity;
8275 {
8276 int modified_top, modified_left;
8277
8278 if (change_gravity > 0)
8279 {
8280 f->top_pos = yoff;
8281 f->left_pos = xoff;
8282 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8283 if (xoff < 0)
8284 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8285 if (yoff < 0)
8286 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8287 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8288 }
8289 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8290
8291 BLOCK_INPUT;
8292 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8293
8294 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8295 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8296 #if 0 /* Running on psilocin (Debian), and displaying on the NCD X-terminal,
8297 this seems to be unnecessary and incorrect. rms, 4/17/97. */
8298 /* It is a mystery why we need to add the border_width here
8299 when the frame is already visible, but experiment says we do. */
8300 if (change_gravity != 0)
8301 {
8302 modified_left += f->border_width;
8303 modified_top += f->border_width;
8304 }
8305 #endif
8306
8307 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8308 modified_left, modified_top);
8309 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8310 }
8311
8312 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8313 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8314 static void
8315 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8316 struct frame *f;
8317 {
8318 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8319 {
8320 int width, height, ign;
8321
8322 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8323
8324 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8325
8326 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8327 when setting WM manager hints.
8328 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8329 x_check_fullscreen_move. */
8330 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8331 {
8332 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8333 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8334 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8335
8336 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8337 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8338 }
8339 }
8340 }
8341
8342 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
8343 the window. This is done in xfns.c.
8344 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
8345 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
8346 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
8347 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
8348 static void
8349 x_check_fullscreen_move (f)
8350 struct frame *f;
8351 {
8352 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_MOVE_WAIT)
8353 {
8354 int expect_top = f->top_pos;
8355 int expect_left = f->left_pos;
8356
8357 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8358 expect_top = 0;
8359 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8360 expect_left = 0;
8361
8362 if (expect_top != f->top_pos || expect_left != f->left_pos)
8363 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 1);
8364
8365 /* Just do this once */
8366 f->want_fullscreen &= ~FULLSCREEN_MOVE_WAIT;
8367 }
8368 }
8369
8370
8371 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8372 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8373 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8374 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8375
8376 static void
8377 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8378 struct frame *f;
8379 int change_gravity;
8380 int cols, rows;
8381 {
8382 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8383
8384 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8385 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8386 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8387 ? 0
8388 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8389 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8390 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8391
8392 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8393
8394 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8395 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8396
8397 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8398 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8399
8400 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8401 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8402 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8403
8404 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8405 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8406 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8407 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8408
8409 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8410 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8411 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8412 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8413 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8414
8415 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8416 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8417 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8418 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8419 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8420
8421 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8422 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8423 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8424 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8425 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8426
8427 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8428 }
8429
8430
8431 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8432 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8433 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8434 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8435
8436 void
8437 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8438 struct frame *f;
8439 int change_gravity;
8440 int cols, rows;
8441 {
8442 BLOCK_INPUT;
8443
8444 #ifdef USE_GTK
8445 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8446 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8447 else
8448 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8449 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8450
8451 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8452 {
8453 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8454 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8455 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8456 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8457 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8458 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8459 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8460 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8461 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8462 }
8463 else
8464 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8465
8466 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8467
8468 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8469
8470 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8471
8472 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8473 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8474
8475 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8476 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8477 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8478 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8479 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8480
8481 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8482 }
8483 \f
8484 /* Mouse warping. */
8485
8486 void
8487 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8488 struct frame *f;
8489 int x, y;
8490 {
8491 int pix_x, pix_y;
8492
8493 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8494 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8495
8496 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8497 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8498
8499 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8500 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8501
8502 BLOCK_INPUT;
8503
8504 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8505 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8506 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8507 }
8508
8509 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8510
8511 void
8512 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8513 struct frame *f;
8514 int pix_x, pix_y;
8515 {
8516 BLOCK_INPUT;
8517
8518 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8519 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8520 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8521 }
8522 \f
8523 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8524
8525 void
8526 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8527 struct frame *f;
8528 {
8529 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8530 x_raise_frame (f);
8531 #endif
8532 #if 0
8533 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8534 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8535 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8536 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8537 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8538 #endif /* ! 0 */
8539 }
8540
8541 void
8542 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8543 struct frame *f;
8544 {
8545 #if 0
8546 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8547 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8548 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8549 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8550 #endif /* ! 0 */
8551 }
8552
8553 /* Raise frame F. */
8554
8555 void
8556 x_raise_frame (f)
8557 struct frame *f;
8558 {
8559 if (f->async_visible)
8560 {
8561 BLOCK_INPUT;
8562 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8563 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8564 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8565 }
8566 }
8567
8568 /* Lower frame F. */
8569
8570 void
8571 x_lower_frame (f)
8572 struct frame *f;
8573 {
8574 if (f->async_visible)
8575 {
8576 BLOCK_INPUT;
8577 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8578 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8579 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8580 }
8581 }
8582
8583 static void
8584 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8585 FRAME_PTR f;
8586 int raise_flag;
8587 {
8588 if (raise_flag)
8589 x_raise_frame (f);
8590 else
8591 x_lower_frame (f);
8592 }
8593 \f
8594 /* Change of visibility. */
8595
8596 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8597 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8598 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8599 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8600 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8601 finishes with it. */
8602
8603 void
8604 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8605 struct frame *f;
8606 {
8607 Lisp_Object type;
8608 int original_top, original_left;
8609 int retry_count = 2;
8610
8611 retry:
8612
8613 BLOCK_INPUT;
8614
8615 type = x_icon_type (f);
8616 if (!NILP (type))
8617 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8618
8619 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8620 {
8621 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8622 call x_set_offset a second time
8623 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8624 before the window gets really visible. */
8625 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8626 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8627 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8628
8629 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8630
8631 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8632 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8633 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8634 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8635 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8636 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8637 #ifdef USE_GTK
8638 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8639 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8640 #else
8641 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8642 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8643 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8644 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8645 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8646 to come back ok without this. */
8647 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8648 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8649 #endif
8650 }
8651
8652 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8653
8654 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8655 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8656 so that incoming events are handled. */
8657 {
8658 Lisp_Object frame;
8659 int count;
8660 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8661 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8662 will set it when they are handled. */
8663 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8664
8665 original_left = f->left_pos;
8666 original_top = f->top_pos;
8667
8668 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8669 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8670
8671 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8672
8673 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8674 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8675 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8676 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8677
8678 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8679 because the window manager may choose the position
8680 and we don't want to override it. */
8681
8682 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8683 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8684 && previously_visible)
8685 {
8686 Drawable rootw;
8687 int x, y;
8688 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8689
8690 BLOCK_INPUT;
8691
8692 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8693 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8694 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8695 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8696 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8697 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8698 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8699 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8700 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8701
8702 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8703 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8704 original_left, original_top);
8705
8706 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8707 }
8708
8709 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8710
8711 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8712 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8713 MapNotify at all.. */
8714 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8715 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8716 {
8717 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8718 x_sync (f);
8719
8720 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
8721 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
8722 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
8723 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
8724 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
8725 probably a bug. */
8726 if (input_polling_used ())
8727 {
8728 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
8729 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
8730 handler reset it. */
8731 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
8732 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
8733 poll_suppress_count = 1;
8734 poll_for_input_1 ();
8735 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
8736 }
8737
8738 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
8739 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8740 }
8741
8742 /* 2000-09-28: In
8743
8744 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
8745 (iconify-frame f)
8746 (raise-frame f))
8747
8748 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
8749 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
8750 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
8751 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
8752
8753 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
8754 goto retry;
8755 }
8756 }
8757
8758 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
8759
8760 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
8761
8762 void
8763 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
8764 struct frame *f;
8765 {
8766 Window window;
8767
8768 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
8769 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8770
8771 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8772 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8773 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8774
8775 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
8776 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
8777 return;
8778 #endif
8779
8780 BLOCK_INPUT;
8781
8782 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
8783 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
8784 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
8785 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
8786 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
8787 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
8788
8789 #ifdef USE_GTK
8790 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8791 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8792 else
8793 #endif
8794 {
8795 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8796
8797 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
8798 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
8799 {
8800 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8801 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
8802 }
8803 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8804
8805 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
8806 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8807 {
8808 XEvent unmap;
8809
8810 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
8811 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
8812 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8813 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
8814 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8815 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8816 False,
8817 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
8818 &unmap))
8819 {
8820 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8821 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
8822 }
8823 }
8824
8825 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
8826 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
8827 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8828 }
8829
8830 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
8831 just by the event that we get from the server.
8832 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
8833 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
8834 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
8835 f->visible = 0;
8836 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
8837 f->async_visible = 0;
8838 f->async_iconified = 0;
8839
8840 x_sync (f);
8841
8842 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8843 }
8844
8845 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
8846
8847 void
8848 x_iconify_frame (f)
8849 struct frame *f;
8850 {
8851 int result;
8852 Lisp_Object type;
8853
8854 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8855 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8856 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8857
8858 if (f->async_iconified)
8859 return;
8860
8861 BLOCK_INPUT;
8862
8863 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8864
8865 type = x_icon_type (f);
8866 if (!NILP (type))
8867 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8868
8869 #ifdef USE_GTK
8870 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8871 {
8872 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8873 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8874
8875 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8876 f->iconified = 1;
8877 f->visible = 1;
8878 f->async_iconified = 1;
8879 f->async_visible = 0;
8880 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8881 return;
8882 }
8883 #endif
8884
8885 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8886
8887 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8888 {
8889 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8890 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8891 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8892 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8893 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
8894 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
8895 so we have to record it here. */
8896 f->iconified = 1;
8897 f->visible = 1;
8898 f->async_iconified = 1;
8899 f->async_visible = 0;
8900 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8901 return;
8902 }
8903
8904 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8905 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
8906 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
8907 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8908
8909 if (!result)
8910 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8911
8912 f->async_iconified = 1;
8913 f->async_visible = 0;
8914
8915
8916 BLOCK_INPUT;
8917 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8918 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8919 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8920
8921 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
8922 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
8923 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
8924 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8925
8926 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
8927 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
8928
8929 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
8930 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
8931 {
8932 XEvent message;
8933
8934 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8935 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8936 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
8937 message.xclient.format = 32;
8938 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
8939
8940 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8941 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8942 False,
8943 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
8944 &message))
8945 {
8946 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8947 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8948 }
8949 }
8950
8951 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
8952 IconicState. */
8953 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8954
8955 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8956 {
8957 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
8958 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8959 }
8960
8961 f->async_iconified = 1;
8962 f->async_visible = 0;
8963
8964 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8965 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8966 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8967 }
8968
8969 \f
8970 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
8971
8972 void
8973 x_free_frame_resources (f)
8974 struct frame *f;
8975 {
8976 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8977 Lisp_Object bar;
8978 struct scroll_bar *b;
8979
8980 BLOCK_INPUT;
8981
8982 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
8983 commands to the X server. */
8984 if (dpyinfo->display)
8985 {
8986 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
8987 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
8988
8989 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8990 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
8991 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
8992 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
8993 toolkit scroll bars. */
8994 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
8995 {
8996 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8997 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
8998 }
8999 #endif
9000
9001 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9002 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9003 free_frame_xic (f);
9004 #endif
9005
9006 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9007 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9008 {
9009 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9010 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9011 }
9012 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9013 we are using a toolkit. */
9014 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9015 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9016
9017 free_frame_menubar (f);
9018 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9019
9020 #ifdef USE_GTK
9021 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
9022 frames. We must check and free both types. */
9023 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9024 {
9025 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9026 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
9027 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
9028 }
9029 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9030
9031 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9032 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9033 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9034
9035 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
9036 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
9037 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9038 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9039 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9040 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9041
9042 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9043 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9044 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9045 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9046 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9047 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9048 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9049 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9050 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9051 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9052 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9053 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9054 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9055 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9056 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9057
9058 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9059 free_frame_faces (f);
9060
9061 x_free_gcs (f);
9062 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9063 }
9064
9065 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9066 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9067
9068 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9069 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9070
9071 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9072 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9073 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9074 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9075 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9076 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9077
9078 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9079 {
9080 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9081 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9082 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9083 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9084 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9085 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9086 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9087 }
9088
9089 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9090 }
9091
9092
9093 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9094
9095 void
9096 x_destroy_window (f)
9097 struct frame *f;
9098 {
9099 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9100
9101 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9102 commands to the X server. */
9103 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9104 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9105
9106 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9107 }
9108
9109 \f
9110 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9111
9112 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9113 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9114 that the window now has.
9115 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9116 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9117 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9118
9119 #ifndef USE_GTK
9120 void
9121 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9122 struct frame *f;
9123 long flags;
9124 int user_position;
9125 {
9126 XSizeHints size_hints;
9127
9128 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9129 Arg al[2];
9130 int ac = 0;
9131 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9132 #endif
9133
9134 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9135
9136 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9137 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9138
9139 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9140 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9141
9142 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9143 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9144 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9145 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9146 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9147 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9148 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9149 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9150 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9151 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9152
9153 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9154 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9155 size_hints.max_width
9156 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9157 size_hints.max_height
9158 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9159
9160 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9161
9162 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9163 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9164 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9165 {
9166 int base_width, base_height;
9167 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9168
9169 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9170 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9171
9172 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9173
9174 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9175 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9176 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9177 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9178 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9179
9180 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9181 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9182 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9183
9184 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9185 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9186 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9187 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9188 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9189 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9190 #else
9191 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9192 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9193 #endif
9194 }
9195
9196 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9197 if (flags)
9198 {
9199 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9200 goto no_read;
9201 }
9202 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9203
9204 {
9205 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9206 long supplied_return;
9207 int value;
9208
9209 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9210 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9211 &supplied_return);
9212 #else
9213 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9214 #endif
9215
9216 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9217 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9218 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9219 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9220 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9221 #endif
9222
9223 if (flags)
9224 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9225 else
9226 {
9227 if (value == 0)
9228 hints.flags = 0;
9229 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9230 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9231 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9232 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9233 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9234 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9235 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9236 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9237 }
9238 }
9239
9240 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9241 no_read:
9242 #endif
9243
9244 #ifdef PWinGravity
9245 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9246 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9247
9248 if (user_position)
9249 {
9250 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9251 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9252 }
9253 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9254
9255 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9256 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9257 #else
9258 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9259 #endif
9260 }
9261 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9262
9263 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9264
9265 void
9266 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9267 struct frame *f;
9268 int state;
9269 {
9270 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9271 Arg al[1];
9272
9273 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9274 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9275 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9276 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9277
9278 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9279 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9280
9281 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9282 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9283 }
9284
9285 void
9286 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9287 struct frame *f;
9288 int pixmap_id;
9289 {
9290 Pixmap icon_pixmap;
9291
9292 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9293 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9294 #endif
9295
9296 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9297 {
9298 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9299 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9300 }
9301 else
9302 {
9303 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9304 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9305 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9306 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9307 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9308 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9309 best to explicitly give up. */
9310 #if 0
9311 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9312 #else
9313 return;
9314 #endif
9315 }
9316
9317 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9318
9319 {
9320 Arg al[1];
9321 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9322 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9323 }
9324
9325 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9326
9327 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPixmapHint;
9328 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9329
9330 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9331 }
9332
9333 void
9334 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9335 struct frame *f;
9336 int icon_x, icon_y;
9337 {
9338 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9339
9340 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9341 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9342 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9343
9344 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9345 }
9346
9347 \f
9348 /***********************************************************************
9349 Fonts
9350 ***********************************************************************/
9351
9352 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9353
9354 struct font_info *
9355 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9356 FRAME_PTR f;
9357 int font_idx;
9358 {
9359 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9360 }
9361
9362
9363 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9364
9365 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9366 to be listed.
9367
9368 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9369
9370 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9371 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9372 on how many fonts to match. */
9373
9374 Lisp_Object
9375 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9376 struct frame *f;
9377 Lisp_Object pattern;
9378 int size;
9379 int maxnames;
9380 {
9381 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9382 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9383 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9384 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9385 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9386 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9387 int count;
9388 int allow_scalable_fonts_p = 0;
9389
9390 if (size < 0)
9391 {
9392 allow_scalable_fonts_p = 1;
9393 size = 0;
9394 }
9395
9396 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9397 if (NILP (patterns))
9398 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9399
9400 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9401 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9402 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9403
9404 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9405 {
9406 int num_fonts;
9407 char **names = NULL;
9408
9409 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9410 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9411 The cache is an alist of the form:
9412 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9413 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9414 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9415 allow_scalable_fonts_p ? Qt : Qnil);
9416 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9417 if (!NILP (list))
9418 {
9419 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9420 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9421 goto label_cached;
9422 }
9423
9424 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9425
9426 BLOCK_INPUT;
9427 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9428
9429 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9430 {
9431 XFontStruct *font;
9432 unsigned long value;
9433
9434 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9435 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9436 {
9437 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9438 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9439 font = NULL;
9440 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9441 }
9442
9443 if (font
9444 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9445 {
9446 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9447 int len = strlen (name);
9448 char *tmp;
9449
9450 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9451 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9452 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9453 if (len == 0)
9454 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9455 else
9456 {
9457 num_fonts = 1;
9458 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9459 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9460 simple var. */
9461 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9462 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9463 XFree (name);
9464 }
9465 }
9466 else
9467 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9468
9469 if (font)
9470 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9471 }
9472
9473 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9474 {
9475 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9476 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9477 if (maxnames < 0)
9478 {
9479 int limit;
9480
9481 for (limit = 500;;)
9482 {
9483 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9484 if (num_fonts == limit)
9485 {
9486 BLOCK_INPUT;
9487 XFreeFontNames (names);
9488 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9489 limit *= 2;
9490 }
9491 else
9492 break;
9493 }
9494 }
9495 else
9496 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9497 &num_fonts);
9498
9499 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9500 {
9501 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9502 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9503 names = NULL;
9504 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9505 }
9506 }
9507
9508 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9509 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9510
9511 if (names)
9512 {
9513 int i;
9514
9515 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9516 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9517 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9518 {
9519 int width = 0;
9520 char *p = names[i];
9521 int average_width = -1, dashes = 0;
9522
9523 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9524 14 dashes, and the field value following 12th dash
9525 (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a auto-scaled font which
9526 is usually too ugly to be used for editing. Let's
9527 ignore it. */
9528 while (*p)
9529 if (*p++ == '-')
9530 {
9531 dashes++;
9532 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9533 width = atoi (p);
9534 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9535 average_width = atoi (p);
9536 }
9537
9538 if (allow_scalable_fonts_p
9539 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0)
9540 {
9541 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9542 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9543 {
9544 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9545 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9546 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9547 >= 0))
9548 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9549 width of this font. */
9550 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9551 else
9552 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9553 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9554 }
9555 }
9556 }
9557
9558 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9559 {
9560 BLOCK_INPUT;
9561 XFreeFontNames (names);
9562 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9563 }
9564 }
9565
9566 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9567 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9568 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9569
9570 label_cached:
9571 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9572
9573 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9574 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9575 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9576 {
9577 int found_size;
9578
9579 tem = XCAR (list);
9580
9581 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9582 continue;
9583 if (!size)
9584 {
9585 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9586 continue;
9587 }
9588
9589 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9590 {
9591 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9592 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9593 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9594
9595 BLOCK_INPUT;
9596 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9597 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9598 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9599 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9600 {
9601 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9602 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9603 thisinfo = NULL;
9604 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9605 }
9606 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9607 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9608
9609 if (thisinfo)
9610 {
9611 XSETCDR (tem,
9612 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9613 ? make_number (0)
9614 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9615 BLOCK_INPUT;
9616 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9617 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9618 }
9619 else
9620 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9621 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9622 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9623 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9624 }
9625
9626 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9627 if (found_size == size)
9628 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9629 else if (found_size > 0)
9630 {
9631 if (NILP (second_best))
9632 second_best = tem;
9633 else if (found_size < size)
9634 {
9635 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9636 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9637 second_best = tem;
9638 }
9639 else
9640 {
9641 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9642 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9643 second_best = tem;
9644 }
9645 }
9646 }
9647 if (!NILP (newlist))
9648 break;
9649 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9650 {
9651 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9652 break;
9653 }
9654 }
9655
9656 return newlist;
9657 }
9658
9659
9660 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9661
9662 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9663 font table. */
9664
9665 static void
9666 x_check_font (f, font)
9667 struct frame *f;
9668 XFontStruct *font;
9669 {
9670 int i;
9671 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9672
9673 xassert (font != NULL);
9674
9675 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9676 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9677 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9678 break;
9679
9680 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9681 }
9682
9683 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9684
9685 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9686 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9687 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9688 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9689 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
9690
9691 static INLINE void
9692 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
9693 XFontStruct *font;
9694 int *w, *h;
9695 {
9696 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9697 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
9698
9699 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
9700 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
9701 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
9702 if (*w <= 0)
9703 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
9704 }
9705
9706
9707 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
9708 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
9709 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
9710 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
9711 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
9712
9713 static int
9714 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
9715 struct frame *f;
9716 {
9717 int i;
9718 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9719 XFontStruct *font;
9720 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
9721 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
9722
9723 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
9724 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
9725
9726 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9727 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
9728 {
9729 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9730 int w, h;
9731
9732 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
9733 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
9734 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
9735
9736 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
9737 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
9738 }
9739
9740 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
9741 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
9742
9743 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
9744 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
9745 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
9746 }
9747
9748
9749 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
9750 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
9751 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
9752 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
9753
9754 struct font_info *
9755 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
9756 struct frame *f;
9757 register char *fontname;
9758 int size;
9759 {
9760 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9761 Lisp_Object font_names;
9762 int count;
9763
9764 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
9765 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
9766 we already have by comparing names. */
9767 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
9768
9769 if (!NILP (font_names))
9770 {
9771 Lisp_Object tail;
9772 int i;
9773
9774 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9775 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
9776 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9777 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
9778 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
9779 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
9780 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
9781 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9782 }
9783
9784 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
9785 {
9786 char *full_name;
9787 XFontStruct *font;
9788 struct font_info *fontp;
9789 unsigned long value;
9790 int i;
9791
9792 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
9793 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
9794 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
9795 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
9796 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
9797 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
9798 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
9799
9800 BLOCK_INPUT;
9801 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9802 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
9803 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9804 {
9805 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9806 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9807 font = NULL;
9808 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9809 }
9810 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
9811 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9812 if (!font)
9813 return NULL;
9814
9815 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
9816 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9817 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
9818 break;
9819
9820 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
9821 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
9822 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
9823 {
9824 int sz;
9825 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
9826 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
9827 dpyinfo->font_table
9828 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
9829 }
9830
9831 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9832 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
9833 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
9834
9835 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
9836 BLOCK_INPUT;
9837 fontp->font = font;
9838 fontp->font_idx = i;
9839 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
9840 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
9841
9842 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
9843 full_name = 0;
9844 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9845 {
9846 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
9847 char *p = name;
9848 int dashes = 0;
9849
9850 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
9851 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
9852 so don't use it.
9853 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
9854 stored in them. */
9855 while (*p)
9856 {
9857 if (*p == '-')
9858 dashes++;
9859 p++;
9860 }
9861
9862 if (dashes >= 13)
9863 {
9864 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
9865 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
9866 }
9867
9868 XFree (name);
9869 }
9870
9871 if (full_name != 0)
9872 fontp->full_name = full_name;
9873 else
9874 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
9875
9876 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
9877 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9878
9879 if (NILP (font_names))
9880 {
9881 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
9882 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
9883 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
9884 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
9885 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
9886 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
9887 Qnil);
9888
9889 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9890 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9891 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9892 make_number (fontp->size)),
9893 Qnil)),
9894 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9895 if (full_name)
9896 {
9897 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
9898 Qnil);
9899 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9900 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9901 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9902 make_number (fontp->size)),
9903 Qnil)),
9904 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9905 }
9906 }
9907
9908 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
9909 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
9910 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
9911 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
9912 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
9913 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
9914 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
9915 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
9916 fontp->encoding[1]
9917 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
9918 /* 1-byte font */
9919 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9920 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9921 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
9922 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
9923 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
9924 /* 2-byte font */
9925 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
9926 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
9927 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9928 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9929 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
9930 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
9931 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
9932 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
9933 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9934 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9935 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
9936 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
9937 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
9938
9939 fontp->baseline_offset
9940 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
9941 ? (long) value : 0);
9942 fontp->relative_compose
9943 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
9944 ? (long) value : 0);
9945 fontp->default_ascent
9946 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
9947 ? (long) value : 0);
9948
9949 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
9950 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
9951 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
9952 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
9953 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
9954 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
9955 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9956 return fontp;
9957 }
9958 }
9959
9960
9961 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
9962 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
9963
9964 struct font_info *
9965 x_query_font (f, fontname)
9966 struct frame *f;
9967 register char *fontname;
9968 {
9969 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9970 int i;
9971
9972 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9973 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9974 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
9975 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
9976 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9977 return NULL;
9978 }
9979
9980
9981 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
9982 `encoder' of the structure. */
9983
9984 void
9985 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
9986 struct font_info *fontp;
9987 {
9988 Lisp_Object list, elt;
9989
9990 elt = Qnil;
9991 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9992 {
9993 elt = XCAR (list);
9994 if (CONSP (elt)
9995 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
9996 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
9997 >= 0)
9998 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
9999 >= 0)))
10000 break;
10001 }
10002
10003 if (! NILP (list))
10004 {
10005 struct ccl_program *ccl
10006 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
10007
10008 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
10009 xfree (ccl);
10010 else
10011 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
10012 }
10013 }
10014
10015
10016 \f
10017 /***********************************************************************
10018 Initialization
10019 ***********************************************************************/
10020
10021 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10022 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10023 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10024 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10025
10026 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10027 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10028 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10029
10030 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10031 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10032 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10033 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10034 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10035 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10036 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10037 };
10038 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10039
10040 static int x_initialized;
10041
10042 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10043 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10044 the screen number from the server number. */
10045 static int
10046 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10047 const char *name1, *name2;
10048 {
10049 int seen_colon = 0;
10050 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10051 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10052 int length_until_period = 0;
10053
10054 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10055 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10056 length_until_period++;
10057
10058 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10059 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10060 name1 += 4;
10061 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10062 name2 += 4;
10063 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10064 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10065 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10066 name1 += system_name_length;
10067 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10068 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10069 name2 += system_name_length;
10070 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10071 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10072 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10073 name1 += length_until_period;
10074 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10075 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10076 name2 += length_until_period;
10077
10078 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10079 {
10080 if (*name1 == ':')
10081 seen_colon++;
10082 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10083 return 1;
10084 }
10085 return (seen_colon
10086 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10087 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10088 }
10089 #endif
10090
10091 struct x_display_info *
10092 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10093 Lisp_Object display_name;
10094 char *xrm_option;
10095 char *resource_name;
10096 {
10097 int connection;
10098 Display *dpy;
10099 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10100 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10101
10102 BLOCK_INPUT;
10103
10104 if (!x_initialized)
10105 {
10106 x_initialize ();
10107 x_initialized = 1;
10108 }
10109
10110 #ifdef USE_GTK
10111 {
10112 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10113 int argc;
10114 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10115 char **argv2 = argv;
10116 GdkAtom atom;
10117
10118 /* GTK 2.0 can only handle one display, GTK 2.2 can handle more
10119 than one, but this remains to be implemented. */
10120 if (x_initialized > 1)
10121 return 0;
10122
10123 x_initialized++;
10124
10125 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10126 argv[argc] = 0;
10127
10128 argc = 0;
10129 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10130
10131 if (! NILP (display_name))
10132 {
10133 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10134 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10135 }
10136
10137 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10138 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10139
10140 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10141 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10142 #endif
10143
10144 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10145
10146 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10147 fixup_locale ();
10148 xg_initialize ();
10149
10150 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10151
10152 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10153 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10154
10155 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10156 {
10157 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
10158 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10159 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10160
10161 GCPRO2 (s, abs_file);
10162 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10163 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name(s, Qnil);
10164
10165 if (! NILP (abs_file) && Ffile_readable_p (abs_file))
10166 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10167
10168 UNGCPRO;
10169 }
10170
10171 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10172 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10173 }
10174 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10175 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10176 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10177 errors with X11R5:
10178 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10179 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10180 So let's not use it until R6. */
10181 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10182 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10183 #endif
10184
10185 {
10186 int argc = 0;
10187 char *argv[3];
10188
10189 argv[0] = "";
10190 argc = 1;
10191 if (xrm_option)
10192 {
10193 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10194 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10195 }
10196 turn_on_atimers (0);
10197 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10198 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10199 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10200 &argc, argv);
10201 turn_on_atimers (1);
10202
10203 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10204 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10205 fixup_locale ();
10206 #endif
10207 }
10208
10209 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10210 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10211 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10212 #endif
10213 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10214 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10215 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10216
10217 /* Detect failure. */
10218 if (dpy == 0)
10219 {
10220 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10221 return 0;
10222 }
10223
10224 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10225
10226 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10227 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10228
10229 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10230 {
10231 struct x_display_info *share;
10232 Lisp_Object tail;
10233
10234 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10235 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10236 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10237 SDATA (display_name)))
10238 break;
10239 if (share)
10240 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10241 else
10242 {
10243 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10244 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10245 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10246 {
10247 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10248 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10249 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10250 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10251 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10252 BLOCK_INPUT;
10253 }
10254
10255 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10256 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10257 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10258 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10259 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10260 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10261 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10262 }
10263 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10264 }
10265 #endif
10266
10267 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10268 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10269 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10270
10271 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10272 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10273 x_display_name_list);
10274 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10275
10276 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10277
10278 #if 0
10279 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10280 #endif /* ! 0 */
10281
10282 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10283 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10284 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10285 + 2);
10286 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10287 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10288
10289 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10290 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10291
10292 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10293 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10294 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10295
10296 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10297 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10298 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10299 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10300 #else
10301 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10302 #endif
10303 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10304 all versions. */
10305 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10306
10307 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10308 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10309 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10310 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10311 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10312 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10313 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10314 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10315 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10316 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10317 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10318 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10319 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10320 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10321 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10322 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10323 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10324 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10325 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10326 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10327 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10328 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10329 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10330 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10331 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10332 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10333 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10334 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10335 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10336 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10337 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10338
10339 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10340 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10341 {
10342 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10343 {
10344 Lisp_Object value;
10345 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10346 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10347 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10348 Qnil, Qnil);
10349 if (STRINGP (value)
10350 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10351 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10352 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10353 }
10354 }
10355 else
10356 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10357 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10358
10359 {
10360 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10361 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10362 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10363 dpyinfo->resy = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10364 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10365 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10366 dpyinfo->resx = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10367 }
10368
10369 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10370 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10371 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10372 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10373 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10374 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10375 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10376 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10377 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10378 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10379 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10380 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10381 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10382 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10383 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10384 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10385 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10386 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10387 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10388 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10389 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10390 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10391 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10392 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10393 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10394 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10395 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10396 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10397 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10398 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10399 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10400 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10401 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10402 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10403 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10404 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10405 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10406 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10407 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10408 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10409 /* For properties of font. */
10410 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10411 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10412 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10413 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10414 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10415 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10416 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10417 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10418
10419 /* Ghostscript support. */
10420 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10421 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10422
10423 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10424 False);
10425
10426 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10427
10428 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10429 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10430
10431 {
10432 char null_bits[1];
10433
10434 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10435
10436 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10437 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10438 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10439 1);
10440 }
10441
10442 {
10443 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10444 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10445 dpyinfo->gray
10446 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10447 gray_bitmap_bits,
10448 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10449 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10450 }
10451
10452 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10453 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10454 #endif
10455
10456 #ifdef subprocesses
10457 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10458 if (connection != 0)
10459 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10460 #endif
10461
10462 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10463 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10464 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10465 /* stdin is a socket here */
10466 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10467 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10468 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10469 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10470 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10471 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10472
10473 #ifdef SIGIO
10474 if (interrupt_input)
10475 init_sigio (connection);
10476 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10477
10478 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10479 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10480 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10481 so that Xt does not crash. */
10482 {
10483 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10484 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10485 Font font;
10486 int count;
10487
10488 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10489 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10490 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10491 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10492 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10493 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10494 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
10495 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10496 abort ();
10497 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10498 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10499 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
10500 }
10501 #endif
10502 #endif
10503
10504 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10505 for debugging X code. */
10506 {
10507 Lisp_Object value;
10508 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10509 build_string ("synchronous"),
10510 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10511 Qnil, Qnil);
10512 if (STRINGP (value)
10513 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10514 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10515 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10516 }
10517
10518 {
10519 Lisp_Object value;
10520 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10521 build_string ("useXIM"),
10522 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10523 Qnil, Qnil);
10524 if (STRINGP (value)
10525 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10526 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10527 use_xim = 0;
10528 }
10529
10530 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10531
10532 return dpyinfo;
10533 }
10534 \f
10535 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10536 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10537
10538 void
10539 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10540 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10541 {
10542 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10543
10544 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10545 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10546 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10547 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10548 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10549 else
10550 {
10551 Lisp_Object tail;
10552
10553 tail = x_display_name_list;
10554 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10555 {
10556 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10557 {
10558 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10559 break;
10560 }
10561 tail = XCDR (tail);
10562 }
10563 }
10564
10565 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10566 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10567
10568 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10569 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10570 else
10571 {
10572 struct x_display_info *tail;
10573
10574 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10575 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10576 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10577 }
10578
10579 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
10580 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
10581 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10582 #endif
10583 #endif
10584 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10585 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
10586 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10587 #endif
10588 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10589 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10590 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10591 #endif
10592
10593 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
10594 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10595 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10596 xfree (dpyinfo);
10597 }
10598
10599 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10600
10601 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10602 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10603 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10604 that slows us down. */
10605
10606 static void
10607 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10608 struct atimer *timer;
10609 {
10610 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10611 {
10612 BLOCK_INPUT;
10613 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10614 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10615 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10616 }
10617 }
10618
10619 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10620
10621 \f
10622 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10623
10624 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10625
10626 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10627 {
10628 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10629 x_produce_glyphs,
10630 x_write_glyphs,
10631 x_insert_glyphs,
10632 x_clear_end_of_line,
10633 x_scroll_run,
10634 x_after_update_window_line,
10635 x_update_window_begin,
10636 x_update_window_end,
10637 x_cursor_to,
10638 x_flush,
10639 #ifndef XFlush
10640 x_flush,
10641 #else
10642 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10643 #endif
10644 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10645 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10646 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10647 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10648 x_per_char_metric,
10649 x_encode_char,
10650 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10651 x_draw_glyph_string,
10652 x_define_frame_cursor,
10653 x_clear_frame_area,
10654 x_draw_window_cursor,
10655 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10656 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10657 };
10658
10659 void
10660 x_initialize ()
10661 {
10662 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10663
10664 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10665 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10666 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10667 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10668 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10669 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10670 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10671 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10672 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10673 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10674 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10675 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10676 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10677 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10678 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10679 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10680 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10681 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10682
10683 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
10684 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10685 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
10686 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
10687 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
10688 off the bottom */
10689 baud_rate = 19200;
10690
10691 x_noop_count = 0;
10692 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10693 any_help_event_p = 0;
10694
10695 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10696 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
10697
10698 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10699 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10700
10701 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10702
10703 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10704 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10705 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10706 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10707 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10708 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10709 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10710
10711 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10712
10713 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10714 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
10715 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
10716 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
10717 widgets don't behave normally. */
10718 {
10719 EMACS_TIME interval;
10720 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10721 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10722 }
10723 #endif
10724
10725 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10726 #ifndef USE_GTK
10727 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10728 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10729 #endif
10730 #endif
10731
10732 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10733 original error handler. */
10734 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10735 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10736
10737 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
10738 #ifdef SIGWINCH
10739 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
10740 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
10741
10742 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10743
10744 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10745 x_session_initialize ();
10746 #endif
10747 }
10748
10749
10750 void
10751 syms_of_xterm ()
10752 {
10753 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
10754 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
10755
10756 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10757 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10758
10759 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10760 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10761
10762 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10763 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10764
10765 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
10766 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
10767 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10768 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
10769
10770 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10771 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10772
10773 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10774 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10775 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10776 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10777 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10778 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
10779 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10780
10781 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10782 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10783 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10784 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10785 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10786 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10787 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
10788 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10789 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
10790 #elif USE_GTK
10791 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
10792 #else
10793 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
10794 #endif
10795 #else
10796 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10797 #endif
10798
10799 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10800 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10801
10802 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
10803 Qalt = intern ("alt");
10804 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10805 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
10806 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10807 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
10808 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10809 Qsuper = intern ("super");
10810 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10811
10812 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10813 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10814 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10815 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10816 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10817 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10818
10819 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10820 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10821 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10822 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10823 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10824 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10825
10826 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10827 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10828 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10829 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10830 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10831 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10832
10833 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10834 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10835 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10836 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10837 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10838 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10839
10840 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10841 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10842 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10843 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10844 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10845 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10846 }
10847
10848 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */